blob: 1a96edb6570012b0d5809de9a0eab355c6997362 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7d1b48f2016-05-10 15:36:58 +02007 2016/05/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200565 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200566 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200568 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100569 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100570 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100571 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200572 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200573 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200574 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - noepoll
577 - nokqueue
578 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300580 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200581 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200582 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200583 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - tune.buffers.limit
585 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200586 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200587 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100588 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100589 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200590 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100591 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100592 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100593 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100594 - tune.lua.session-timeout
595 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200596 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100597 - tune.maxaccept
598 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200600 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200601 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100602 - tune.rcvbuf.client
603 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100604 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100605 - tune.sndbuf.client
606 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100607 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100608 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200609 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100610 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200611 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200612 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200613 - tune.vars.global-max-size
614 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
615 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
616 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100617 - tune.zlib.memlevel
618 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100619
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620 * Debugging
621 - debug
622 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623
624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006253.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626------------------------------------
627
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200628ca-base <dir>
629 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200630 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
631 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633chroot <jail dir>
634 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
635 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
636 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
637 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
638 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
639 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100640
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100641cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
642 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
643 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
644 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100645 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
646 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
647 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
648 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
649 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
650 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
651 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
652 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
653 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
654 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100655
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200656crt-base <dir>
657 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
658 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
659 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
660
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661daemon
662 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
663 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
664 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
665
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200666deviceatlas-json-file <path>
667 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
668 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
669
670deviceatlas-log-level <value>
671 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
672 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
673
674deviceatlas-separator <char>
675 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
676 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
677
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100678deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200679 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
680 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
681 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100682
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900683external-check
684 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
685 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
686 See "option external-check".
687
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200688gid <number>
689 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
690 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
691 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100692 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
693 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100695
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200696group <group name>
697 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
698 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100699
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200700log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
702 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100703 configured with "log global".
704
705 <address> can be one of:
706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100707 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100708 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
709 port).
710
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100711 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
712 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
713 port).
714
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100715 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
716 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
717 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
718 writeable).
719
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200720 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
721 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100722
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200723 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
724 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
725 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
726 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
727 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
728 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
729 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
730 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
731 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
732 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
733 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
734
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200735 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
736 one of the following :
737
738 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
739 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
740
741 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
742 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
743
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100744 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200745
746 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
747 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
748 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
749
750 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200751 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
752 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
753 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
754 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
755 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
756 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200758 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200759
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100760log-send-hostname [<string>]
761 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
762 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
763 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
764 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
765 the logs.
766
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000767log-tag <string>
768 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
769 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
770 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100771 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000772
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100773lua-load <file>
774 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
775 used multiple times.
776
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200777nbproc <number>
778 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
779 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
780 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
781 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
782 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
783
784pidfile <pidfile>
785 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
786 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
787 starting the process. See also "daemon".
788
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100789presetenv <name> <value>
790 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
791 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
792 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
793 and "unsetenv".
794
795resetenv [<name> ...]
796 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
797 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
798 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
799 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
800 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
801 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
802 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
803 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
804
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100805stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200806 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
807 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
808 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
809 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
810 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
811 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100812 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200813 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
814 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200815
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200816server-state-base <directory>
817 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200818 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
819 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200820
821server-state-file <file>
822 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
823 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
824 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
825 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
826 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
827 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
828 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
829 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200830 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
831 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200832
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100833setenv <name> <value>
834 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
835 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
836 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
837 and "unsetenv".
838
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100839ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
841 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300842 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100843 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
844 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
845 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
846 "bind" keyword for more information.
847
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100848ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
850 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
851 keyword to see available options.
852
853 Example:
854 global
855 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
856
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100857ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
859 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300860 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100861 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
862 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
863 information.
864
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100865ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
867 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
868 keyword to see available options.
869
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200870ssl-dh-param-file <file>
871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
872 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
873 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
874 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
875 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200876 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
877 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
878 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
879 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200880 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
881 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
882 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
883
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100884ssl-server-verify [none|required]
885 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
886 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
887 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
888
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200889stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
890 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
891 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
892 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200893 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
894 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200895
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200896 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
897 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
898 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200899
900stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
901 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
902 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100903 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200904
905stats maxconn <connections>
906 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
907 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
908
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200909uid <number>
910 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
911 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
912 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
913 one. See also "gid" and "user".
914
915ulimit-n <number>
916 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
917 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
918 option.
919
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100920unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
921 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
922
923 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
924 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
925 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
926 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
927 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
928 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
929 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
930 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
931 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
932 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
933
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100934unsetenv [<name> ...]
935 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
936 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
937 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
938 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
939 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
940 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
941 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
942
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200943user <user name>
944 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
945 See also "uid" and "group".
946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200947node <name>
948 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
949
950 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
951 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
952 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
953 traffic.
954
955description <text>
956 Add a text that describes the instance.
957
958 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
959 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
960 "<" and ">" characters.
961
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096251degrees-data-file <file path>
963 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
964 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
965
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200966 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100967 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
968
96951degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
970 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
971 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
972 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
973
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200974 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100975 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
976
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100978 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
979 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
980
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200981 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
982 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
983
98451degrees-cache-size <number>
985 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
986 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
987 By default, this cache is disabled.
988
989 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100990 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
991
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009933.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994-----------------------
995
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200996max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
997 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
998 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
999 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1000 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1001 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1002 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1003 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1004 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006maxconn <number>
1007 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1008 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1009 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001010 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1011 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1012 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1013 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001014 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1015 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1016 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1017 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1018 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001020maxconnrate <number>
1021 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1022 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1023 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1024 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1025 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1026 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1027 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1028 fairness.
1029
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001030maxcomprate <number>
1031 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001032 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001033 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1034 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1035 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1036 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1037 default value.
1038
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001039maxcompcpuusage <number>
1040 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1041 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1042 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1043 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1044 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1045 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1046 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1047 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1048
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001049maxpipes <number>
1050 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1051 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1052 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1053 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1054 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1055 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1056
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057maxsessrate <number>
1058 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1059 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1060 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1061 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1062 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1063 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1064 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1065 fairness.
1066
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001067maxsslconn <number>
1068 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1069 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1070 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1071 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1072 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1073 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1074 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001075 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1076 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1077 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1078 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1079 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1080 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1081 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001082
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001083maxsslrate <number>
1084 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1085 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1086 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1087 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1088 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1089 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1090 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1091 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1092 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1093 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1094
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001095maxzlibmem <number>
1096 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1097 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1098 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001099 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1100 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1101 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103noepoll
1104 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1105 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001106 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107
1108nokqueue
1109 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1110 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1111 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1112
1113nopoll
1114 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1115 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001116 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001117 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001118
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001119nosplice
1120 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1121 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1122 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001123 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001124 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1125 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1126 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1127 "option splice-response".
1128
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001129nogetaddrinfo
1130 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1131 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1132
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001133spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001134 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1135 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1136 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1137 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1138 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1139 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001140
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001141tune.buffers.limit <number>
1142 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1143 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1144 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1145 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1146 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1147 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1148 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1149 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1150 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1151 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1152 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1153 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1154 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1155 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1156 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1157
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001158tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1159 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1160 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1161 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1162 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1163
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001164tune.bufsize <number>
1165 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1166 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1167 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1168 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1169 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1170 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1171 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1172 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001173 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1174 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1175 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001176
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001177tune.chksize <number>
1178 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1179 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1180 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1181 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1182 checks whenever possible.
1183
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001184tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1185 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1186 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1187 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1188 this value. The default value is 1.
1189
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001190tune.http.cookielen <number>
1191 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1192 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1193 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1194 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1195 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1196 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1197 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1198 to change this value.
1199
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001200tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1201 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1202 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1203 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1204 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1205 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1206 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1207 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1208 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1209 limit too high.
1210
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001211tune.idletimer <timeout>
1212 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1213 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1214 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1215 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1216 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1217 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1218 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1219 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1220 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1221
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001222tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1223 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1224 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1225 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1226 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1227 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1228 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1229 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1230
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001231tune.lua.maxmem
1232 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1233 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1234 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1235 memory.
1236
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001237tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1238 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001239 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1240 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1241 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001242
1243tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1244 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1245 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1246 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1247 check servers.
1248
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001249tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1250 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1251 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1252 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1253 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1254
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001255tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001256 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1257 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1258 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1259 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1260 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1261 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1262 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1263 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1264 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1265 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001266
1267tune.maxpollevents <number>
1268 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1269 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1270 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1271 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1272 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1273
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001274tune.maxrewrite <number>
1275 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1276 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1277 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1278 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1279 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1280 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1281 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1282 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1283 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1284 bufsize.
1285
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001286tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1287 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1288 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1289 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1290 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1291 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1292 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1293 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1294 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1295 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1296 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1297 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1298 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1299 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1300 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1301 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1302 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1303 setting this parameter to 0.
1304
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001305tune.pipesize <number>
1306 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1307 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1308 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1309 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1310 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1311 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1312
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001313tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1314tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1315 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1316 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1317 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1318 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1319 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1320 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1321 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1322
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001323tune.recv_enough <number>
1324 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1325 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1326 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1327 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1328 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1329
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001330tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1331tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1332 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1333 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1334 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1335 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1336 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1337 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1338 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1339 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1340 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1341 notifying haproxy again.
1342
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001343tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001344 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1345 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1346 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001347 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001348 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1349 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1350 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1351 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1352 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001353 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1354 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001355
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001356tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1357 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1358 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1359 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1360 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1361 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1362 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1363
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001364tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1365 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001366 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001367 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1368 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1369 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1370 being used for too long.
1371
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001372tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1373 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1374 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1375 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1376 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1377 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1378 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1379 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1380 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1381 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1382 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001383 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1384 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001385
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001386tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1387 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1388 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1389 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1390 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1391 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1392 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1393 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001394 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1395 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001396
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001397tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1398 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1399 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1400 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1401 1000 entries.
1402
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001403tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1404tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1405tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1406tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001407 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1408 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1409 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1410 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1411 response processing.
1412 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1413 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1414 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001415
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001416 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1417 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1418 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1419 all available space is consumed.
1420 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1421 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1422 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001423
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001424tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1425 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001426 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001427 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1428 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1429 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1430
1431tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1432 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1433 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1434 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1435 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014373.3. Debugging
1438--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
1440debug
1441 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1442 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1443 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1444 system startup.
1445
1446quiet
1447 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1448 line argument "-q".
1449
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014513.4. Userlists
1452--------------
1453It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1454http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1455it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1456
1457userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001458 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001459 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1460
1461group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001462 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001463 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1464 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1465
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001466user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1467 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001468 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1469 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001470 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1471 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001472 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001473 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001474
1475
1476 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001477 userlist L1
1478 group G1 users tiger,scott
1479 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001480
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001481 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1482 user scott insecure-password elgato
1483 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001484
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001485 userlist L2
1486 group G1
1487 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001488
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001489 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1490 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1491 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001492
1493 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001494
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001495
14963.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001497----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001498It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1499several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1500instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1501values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1502automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1503In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1504using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1505tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1506reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1507Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1508that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1509each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001510
1511peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001512 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001513 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1514
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001515disabled
1516 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1517 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1518 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1519
1520enable
1521 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1522
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001523peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1524 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1525 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1526 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1527 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1528 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1529 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1530
1531 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1532 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1533
1534 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1535 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1536 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1537 across all peers.
1538
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001539 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1540 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001541
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001542 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001543 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001544 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1545 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1546 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001547
1548 backend mybackend
1549 mode tcp
1550 balance roundrobin
1551 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1552 stick on src
1553
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001554 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1555 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001556
1557
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015583.6. Mailers
1559------------
1560It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1561If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1562in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1563
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001564mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001565 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1566 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1567
1568mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1569 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1570
1571 Example:
1572 mailers mymailers
1573 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1574 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1575
1576 backend mybackend
1577 mode tcp
1578 balance roundrobin
1579
1580 email-alert mailers mymailers
1581 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1582 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1583
1584 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1585 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1586
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001587timeout mail <time>
1588 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1589 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1590 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1591 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1592
1593 Example:
1594 mailers mymailers
1595 timeout mail 20s
1596 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001599----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001601Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001602 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603 - frontend <name>
1604 - backend <name>
1605 - listen <name>
1606
1607A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1608its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1609section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001610section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001611
1612A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1613connections.
1614
1615A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1616to forward incoming connections.
1617
1618A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1619parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001621All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1622'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1623case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1624
1625Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1626logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1627proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1628However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1629name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1630
1631Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1632and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001633bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001634protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1635modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1636arbitrary criteria.
1637
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001638In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1639a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1640the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1641
1642 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1643 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1644 between responses and new requests.
1645
1646 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1647 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1648 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1649 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1650
1651 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1652 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1653 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1654
1655 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1656 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1657 client-facing connection remains open.
1658
1659 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1660 after the end of the response.
1661
1662The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1663frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1664following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1665weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1666
1667 Backend mode
1668
1669 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1670 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1671 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1672 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1673 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1674 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1675 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1676 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1677 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1678 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1679 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016834.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1684--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001686The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1687limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1688they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1689limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001690marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001691option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001692and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1693with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1694specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001696
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001697 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1698------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1699acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001700appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001701backlog X X X -
1702balance X - X X
1703bind - X X -
1704bind-process X X X X
1705block - X X X
1706capture cookie - X X -
1707capture request header - X X -
1708capture response header - X X -
1709clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001710compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001711contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1712cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001713declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001714default-server X - X X
1715default_backend X X X -
1716description - X X X
1717disabled X X X X
1718dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001719email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001720email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001721email-alert mailers X X X X
1722email-alert myhostname X X X X
1723email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001724enabled X X X X
1725errorfile X X X X
1726errorloc X X X X
1727errorloc302 X X X X
1728-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1729errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001730force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001731filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001732fullconn X - X X
1733grace X X X X
1734hash-type X - X X
1735http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001736http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001737http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001738http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001739http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001740http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001741http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001742id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001743ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001744load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001745log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001746log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001747log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001748log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001749max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001750maxconn X X X -
1751mode X X X X
1752monitor fail - X X -
1753monitor-net X X X -
1754monitor-uri X X X -
1755option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1756option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1757option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1758option allbackups (*) X - X X
1759option checkcache (*) X - X X
1760option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1761option contstats (*) X X X -
1762option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1763option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1764option forceclose (*) X X X X
1765-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1766option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001767option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001768option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001769option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001770option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001771option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001772option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001773option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001774option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1775option httpchk X - X X
1776option httpclose (*) X X X X
1777option httplog X X X X
1778option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001779option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001780option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001781option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001782option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1783option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1784option logasap (*) X X X -
1785option mysql-check X - X X
1786option nolinger (*) X X X X
1787option originalto X X X X
1788option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001789option pgsql-check X - X X
1790option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001791option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001792option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001793option smtpchk X - X X
1794option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1795option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1796option splice-request (*) X X X X
1797option splice-response (*) X X X X
1798option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1799option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1800-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001801option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001802option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1803option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1804option tcpka X X X X
1805option tcplog X X X X
1806option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001807external-check command X - X X
1808external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001809persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1810rate-limit sessions X X X -
1811redirect - X X X
1812redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1813redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1814reqadd - X X X
1815reqallow - X X X
1816reqdel - X X X
1817reqdeny - X X X
1818reqiallow - X X X
1819reqidel - X X X
1820reqideny - X X X
1821reqipass - X X X
1822reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823reqitarpit - X X X
1824reqpass - X X X
1825reqrep - X X X
1826-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827reqtarpit - X X X
1828retries X - X X
1829rspadd - X X X
1830rspdel - X X X
1831rspdeny - X X X
1832rspidel - X X X
1833rspideny - X X X
1834rspirep - X X X
1835rsprep - X X X
1836server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001837server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001838source X - X X
1839srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001840stats admin - X X X
1841stats auth X X X X
1842stats enable X X X X
1843stats hide-version X X X X
1844stats http-request - X X X
1845stats realm X X X X
1846stats refresh X X X X
1847stats scope X X X X
1848stats show-desc X X X X
1849stats show-legends X X X X
1850stats show-node X X X X
1851stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001852-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1853stick match - - X X
1854stick on - - X X
1855stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001856stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001858tcp-check connect - - X X
1859tcp-check expect - - X X
1860tcp-check send - - X X
1861tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001862tcp-request connection - X X -
1863tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001864tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001865tcp-response content - - X X
1866tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001867timeout check X - X X
1868timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001869timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001870timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1871timeout connect X - X X
1872timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1873timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1874timeout http-request X X X X
1875timeout queue X - X X
1876timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001877timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001878timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1879timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001880timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001881transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001882unique-id-format X X X -
1883unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001884use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001885use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001886------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1887 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018904.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1891---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
1893This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1894
1895
1896acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1897 Declare or complete an access list.
1898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1899 no | yes | yes | yes
1900 Example:
1901 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1902 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1903 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001905 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906
1907
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001908appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1909 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001910 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1912 no | no | yes | yes
1913 Arguments :
1914 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1915 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1916
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001917 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918 checked in each cookie value.
1919
1920 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1921 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1922 milliseconds.
1923
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001924 request-learn
1925 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1926 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1927 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1928 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1929 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1930 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1931
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001932 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1933 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1934 data following this prefix.
1935
1936 Example :
1937 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1938
1939 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1940 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1941
1942 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1943 2 modes are currently supported :
1944 - path-parameters :
1945 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1946 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1947 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1948 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1949 - query-string :
1950 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1951 query string.
1952
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001953 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1954 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1955 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001957 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1958 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959
1960
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001961backlog <conns>
1962 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1964 yes | yes | yes | no
1965 Arguments :
1966 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1967 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001968 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001969
1970 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1971 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1972 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1973 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1974 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1975 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1976 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1977 backlog parameter.
1978
1979 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1980 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1981 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1982
1983 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1984
1985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001987balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001988 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1990 yes | no | yes | yes
1991 Arguments :
1992 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1993 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1994 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1995 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1996
1997 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1998 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1999 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2000 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002001 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002002 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002003 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2004 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2005 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2006 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2007 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2008 it, so that you don't worry.
2009
2010 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2011 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2012 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2013 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2014 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2015 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2016 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2017 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002018
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002019 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2020 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2021 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2022 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2023 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2024 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2025 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2026 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2027
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002028 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002029 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002030 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2031 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002032 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002033 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2034 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2035 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2036 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2037 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002038 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2039 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2040 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2041 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2042 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2043 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2046 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2047 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2048 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2049 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2050 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2051 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2052 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002053 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002055 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2056 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2057 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002059 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2060 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2061 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2062 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2063 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2064 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2065 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2066 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2067 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2068 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2069 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2070 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002072 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002073 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2074 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2075 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2076 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2077 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2078 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2079 URIs start with a leading "/".
2080
2081 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2082 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2083 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2084 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002087 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2088
2089 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002090 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2091 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002092 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2093 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2094 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2095 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002097 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2098 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002099
2100 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2101 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2102 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2103 server will receive the request.
2104
2105 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2106 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2107 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2108 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2109 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002110 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2111 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2112 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002113
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002114 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2115 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2116 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2117 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2118 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002120 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002121 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2122 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2123 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2124
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002125 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2126 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2127 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2128
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002129 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002130 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002131 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2132 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2133 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2134 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2135 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2136 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002137 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002138 used instead.
2139
2140 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2141 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2142 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2143 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2144
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002145 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2146 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2147 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2148
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002149 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002152 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2153 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002154
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002155 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2156 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2157 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158
2159 Examples :
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002162 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002163 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2164 balance hdr(host)
2165 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002166
2167 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2168 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002170 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002171 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2172 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2173 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2174 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2175
2176 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2177 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2178 defaults to 16 kB.
2179
2180 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2181 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2182
2183 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2184 Round Robin.
2185
2186 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2187 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2188 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2189 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2190
2191 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2192
2193 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002194 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002195 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2196 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2197 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002199 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200
2201
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002202bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2203bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2206 no | yes | yes | no
2207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002208 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2209 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2210 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2211 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002212 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002213 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2214 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2215 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2216 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2217 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2218 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2219 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002220 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2221 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2222 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2223 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2224 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2225 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2226 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002227 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2228 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2229 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002230 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2231 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2232 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002233
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002234 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2235 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002236 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2237 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2238 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002239 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2240 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2241 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2242 the range.
2243
2244 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2245 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2246 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2247 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2248 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2249 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2250 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002251 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002252 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002253
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002254 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2255 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2256 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2257 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2258 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2259 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2260 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2261 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2262
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002263 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2264 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2265 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2266 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2269 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2270 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2271 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2272 in a frontend.
2273
2274 Example :
2275 listen http_proxy
2276 bind :80,:443
2277 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002278 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002280 listen http_https_proxy
2281 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002282 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002283
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002284 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2285 bind ipv6@:80
2286 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2287 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2288
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002289 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002290 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002291
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002292 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2293 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2294 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2295 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2296 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2297
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002298 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002299 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
2301
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002302bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002303 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2305 yes | yes | yes | yes
2306 Arguments :
2307 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2308 may be used to override a default value.
2309
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002310 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002311 option may be combined with other numbers.
2312
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002313 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002314 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2315 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2316 missing from all processes.
2317
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002318 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002319 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002320 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2321 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2322 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2323 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002324
2325 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2326 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2327 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2328 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2329 and 'even' instances.
2330
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002331 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2332 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2333 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2334 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002335
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002336 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2337 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2338
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002339 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2340 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2341 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2342
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002343 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2344 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2345
2346 Example :
2347 listen app_ip1
2348 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002349 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002350
2351 listen app_ip2
2352 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002353 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002354
2355 listen management
2356 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002357 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002358
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002359 listen management
2360 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2361 bind-process 1-4
2362
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002363 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002364
2365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002366block { if | unless } <condition>
2367 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 no | yes | yes | yes
2370
2371 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2372 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002373 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002374 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2376 "block" statements per instance.
2377
2378 Example:
2379 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2380 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2381 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2382 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002384 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385
2386
2387capture cookie <name> len <length>
2388 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2390 no | yes | yes | no
2391 Arguments :
2392 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2393 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2394 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2395 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2396 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2397
2398 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2399 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2400 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2401 right if it exceeds <length>.
2402
2403 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2404 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2405 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2406 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2407
2408 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2409 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2410 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2411
2412 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2413 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2414 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002415 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2416 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2417 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418
2419 Example:
2420 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2421
2422 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002423 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
2425
2426capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002427 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2429 no | yes | yes | no
2430 Arguments :
2431 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002432 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2434 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2435 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2436
2437 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2438 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2439 it exceeds <length>.
2440
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002441 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2443 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002444 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2445 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2446 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2447 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002448 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002449 environments to find where the request came from.
2450
2451 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2452 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2453 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2454 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002456 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2457 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2458 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2459 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2460 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
2462 Example:
2463 capture request header Host len 15
2464 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002465 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002467 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 about logging.
2469
2470
2471capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002472 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2474 no | yes | yes | no
2475 Arguments :
2476 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002477 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2479 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2480 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2481
2482 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2483 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2484 it exceeds <length>.
2485
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002486 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002487 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2488 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2489 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002490 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2491 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2492 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2493 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002494
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002495 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2496 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2497 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2498 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2499 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002500
2501 Example:
2502 capture response header Content-length len 9
2503 capture response header Location len 15
2504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002505 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506 about logging.
2507
2508
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002509clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2512 yes | yes | yes | no
2513 Arguments :
2514 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2515 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2516 as explained at the top of this document.
2517
2518 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2519 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2520 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2521 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2522 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2523 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2524 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2525 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002526 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2528 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2529
2530 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2531 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2532 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2533 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2534 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2535 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2536
2537 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2538 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2539
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002540 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2541 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002543compression algo <algorithm> ...
2544compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002545compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002546 Enable HTTP compression.
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 yes | yes | yes | yes
2549 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002550 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2551 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2552 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2553
2554 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002555 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2556 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2557 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002558
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002559 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002560 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002561
2562 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2563 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2564 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2565 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2566 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002567 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002568
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002569 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2570 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2571 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2572 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2573 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2574 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2575 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002576 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002577
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002578 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002579 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002580 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2581 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2582 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2583 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2584 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002585
2586 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2587 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2588 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2589 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2590 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002591 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2592 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2593 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2594 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2595 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002596 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2597 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002598
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002599 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002600 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2601 "Accept-Encoding" header
2602 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002603 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002604 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2605 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002606 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2607 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2608 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2609 "multipart"
2610 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2611 header
2612 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2613 and later
2614 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2615 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002616
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002617 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2618 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002619
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002620 Examples :
2621 compression algo gzip
2622 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002624
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002625contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2628 yes | no | yes | yes
2629 Arguments :
2630 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2631 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2632 as explained at the top of this document.
2633
2634 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002635 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002636 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2638 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2639 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2640 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2641
2642 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2643 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2644 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2645 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2646 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2647 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2648
2649 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2650 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2651 instead.
2652
2653 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2654 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2655
2656
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002657cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002658 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2659 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2662 yes | no | yes | yes
2663 Arguments :
2664 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2665 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2666 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2667 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2668 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2669 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2670 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2671 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2672 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2673
2674 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2675 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2676 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2677 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2678 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2679 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002680 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2681 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2682 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2683 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2684 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002685
2686 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002687 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002688
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002689 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002690 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2691 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2692 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2693 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2694 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2695 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2696 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2697 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2698 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2699 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700
2701 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2702 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2703 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2704 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2705 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2706 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2707 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2708 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2709 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002710 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002711 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2712 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2713 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002714
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002715 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2716 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2717 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002718 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2719 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2720 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2721 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002722 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2723 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2724 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
2726 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2727 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2728 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2729 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2730 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2731 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2732 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2733 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2734 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2735
2736 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2737 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2738 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2739 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2740 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2741 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2742 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2743 persistence cookie in the cache.
2744 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2745
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002746 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2747 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2748 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2749 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2750 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2751 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2752 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2753 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2754 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2755 they logout.
2756
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002757 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2758 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2759 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2760 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2761
2762 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2763 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2764 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2765 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2766 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2767 this attribute.
2768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002769 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002770 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002771 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2772 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2773 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2774 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2775 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2776 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002777
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002778 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2779 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2780 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2781 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2782 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2783 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2784 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2785 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2786 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2787 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2788 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2789 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2790 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2791 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2792 the site.
2793
2794 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2795 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2796 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2797 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2798 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2799 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2800 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2801 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2802 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2803 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2804 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2805 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2806 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2807 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2808 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2809 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2812 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2813 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2814 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816 Examples :
2817 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2818 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2819 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002820 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002822 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002824
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002825declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2826 Declares a capture slot.
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 no | yes | yes | no
2829 Arguments:
2830 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2831
2832 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2833 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2834 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2835 for use in the response.
2836
2837 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002838 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002839 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2840
2841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002842default-server [param*]
2843 Change default options for a server in a backend
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | no | yes | yes
2846 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002847 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2848 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2849 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2850 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002851
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002852 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002853 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2854
2855 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002856
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858default_backend <backend>
2859 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2861 yes | yes | yes | no
2862 Arguments :
2863 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2864
2865 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2866 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2867 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2868 will catch all undetermined requests.
2869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870 Example :
2871
2872 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2873 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2874 default_backend dynamic
2875
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002876 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002879description <string>
2880 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 no | yes | yes | yes
2883 Arguments : string
2884
2885 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2886 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2887 it describes.
2888 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2889
2890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891disabled
2892 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2894 yes | yes | yes | yes
2895 Arguments : none
2896
2897 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2898 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2899 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2900 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2901 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2902 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2903 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2904
2905 See also : "enabled"
2906
2907
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002908dispatch <address>:<port>
2909 Set a default server address
2910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2911 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002913
2914 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2915 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2916 during start-up.
2917
2918 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2919 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2920 possible with normal servers.
2921
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002922 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002923 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2924 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2925 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2926 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2927
2928 See also : "server"
2929
2930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931enabled
2932 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | yes
2935 Arguments : none
2936
2937 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2938 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2939
2940 See also : "disabled"
2941
2942
2943errorfile <code> <file>
2944 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | yes | yes | yes
2947 Arguments :
2948 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002949 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2950 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
2952 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002953 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002955 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2956 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957
2958 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2959 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2960 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2961
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002962 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2965 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2966 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2967 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2968
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002969 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2970 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2971 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2972 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2973 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2974 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002976 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2977 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2978 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002979 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002980 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2981
2982 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2983
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002984 Example :
2985 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002986 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002987 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2988 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002990
2991errorloc <code> <url>
2992errorloc302 <code> <url>
2993 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2995 yes | yes | yes | yes
2996 Arguments :
2997 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002998 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002999
3000 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3001 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3002 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3003 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3004 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3005
3006 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3007 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3008 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3009
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003010 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3011
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003012 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3013 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3014 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3015 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003016 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003017 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3018 request.
3019
3020 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3021
3022
3023errorloc303 <code> <url>
3024 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3026 yes | yes | yes | yes
3027 Arguments :
3028 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3029 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3030
3031 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3032 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3033 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3034 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3035 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3036
3037 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3038 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3039 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3040
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003041 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3042
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003043 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3044 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3045 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3046 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003047 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003048
3049 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3050
3051
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003052email-alert from <emailaddr>
3053 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3054 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 yes | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 Arguments :
3059
3060 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3061
3062 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3063 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3064
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003065 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003066 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3067 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003068
3069
3070email-alert level <level>
3071 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3072 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 yes | yes | yes | yes
3075
3076 Arguments :
3077
3078 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3079 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3080 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3081
3082 By default level is alert
3083
3084 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3085 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3086 for the proxy.
3087
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003088 Alerts are sent when :
3089
3090 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3091 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3092 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3093 is notice or lower
3094 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3095 and a health check status update occurs
3096
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003097 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3098 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003099 section 3.6 about mailers.
3100
3101
3102email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3103 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3104 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3105 yes | yes | yes | yes
3106
3107 Arguments :
3108
3109 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3110
3111 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3112 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3113
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003114 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3115 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003116
3117
3118email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3119 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3120 mailers.
3121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3122 yes | yes | yes | yes
3123
3124 Arguments :
3125
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003126 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003127
3128 By default the systems hostname is used.
3129
3130 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3131 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3132 for the proxy.
3133
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003134 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3135 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003136
3137
3138email-alert to <emailaddr>
3139 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3140 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3142 yes | yes | yes | yes
3143
3144 Arguments :
3145
3146 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3147
3148 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3149 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3150
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003151 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003152 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3153
3154
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003155force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3156 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3157 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3158 no | yes | yes | yes
3159
3160 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3161 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3162 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3163 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3164 marked down for maintenance operations.
3165
3166 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3167 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3168 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3169 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3170 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3171 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3172 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3173 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3174 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3175
3176 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3177 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3178 is used.
3179
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003180 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003181 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003182
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003183
3184filter <name> [param*]
3185 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 no | yes | yes | yes
3188 Arguments :
3189 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3190 referenced in section 9.
3191
3192 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3193 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3194 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3195 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3196
3197 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3198 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3199
3200 Example:
3201 listen
3202 bind *:80
3203
3204 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3205 filter compression
3206 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3207
3208 compression algo gzip
3209 compression offload
3210
3211 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3212
3213 See also : section 9.
3214
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003216fullconn <conns>
3217 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3219 yes | no | yes | yes
3220 Arguments :
3221 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3222 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3223
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003224 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003225 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003226 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003227 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3228 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3229 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3230 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3231 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003232 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003233
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003234 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3235 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003236 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3237 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3238 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003239
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003240 Example :
3241 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3242 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3243 # connections.
3244 backend dynamic
3245 fullconn 10000
3246 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3247 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3248
3249 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3250
3251
3252grace <time>
3253 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003255 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003256 Arguments :
3257 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3258 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3259 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3260
3261 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3262 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003263 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003264 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3265
3266 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3267 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3268 simplify it.
3269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003270
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003271hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003272 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3274 yes | no | yes | yes
3275 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003276 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3277 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003278
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003279 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3280 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3281 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3282 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3283 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3284 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3285 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3286 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3287 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3288 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003289
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003290 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3291 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3292 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3293 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3294 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3295 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3296 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3297 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3298 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3299 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3300 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3301 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3302 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003303 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3304 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003305
3306 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3307
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003308 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003309 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3310 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3311 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003312 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3313 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3314 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003315
3316 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3317 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003318 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3319 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3320 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3321 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3322
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003323 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3324 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3325 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3326 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3327 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3328 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3329 parameter.
3330
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003331 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3332 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3333 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3334 used on strings.
3335
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003336 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3337
3338 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3339 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3340 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3341 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3342 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3343 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3344 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3345 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3346 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3347 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3348 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3349 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003350
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003351 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3352 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3353 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003354
3355 See also : "balance", "server"
3356
3357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358http-check disable-on-404
3359 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003361 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362 Arguments : none
3363
3364 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3365 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3366 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3367 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3368 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3369 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3370 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3371 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003372 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3373 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3374 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3375
3376 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3377
3378
3379http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003380 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003382 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003383 Arguments :
3384 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3385 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003386 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003387 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3388 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3389 details on the supported keywords.
3390
3391 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3392 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3393 with the usual backslash ('\').
3394
3395 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3396 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3397 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3398 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3399 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3400
3401 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003402 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003403 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3404 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3405 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3406
3407 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003409 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3410 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3411 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3412 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3413
3414 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003415 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003416 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3417 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3418 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3419 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3420 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3421 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3422 trace).
3423
3424 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003425 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003426 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3427 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3428 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3429 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3430 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3431 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3432
3433 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3434 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3435 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3436 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3437 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3438 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3439 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3440 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3441
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003442 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3443 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3444 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3445
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003446 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3447 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3448
3449 Examples :
3450 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003451 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003452
3453 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003454 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003455
3456 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003457 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003458
3459 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003460 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003462 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003463
3464
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003465http-check send-state
3466 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3468 yes | no | yes | yes
3469 Arguments : none
3470
3471 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3472 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3473 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3474 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3475 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3476
3477 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3478 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3479 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3480 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3481 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003482 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3483 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3484 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3485
3486 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3487 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3488 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3489
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003490 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3491 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3492 checked in multiple backends.
3493
3494 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3495 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3496
3497 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3498 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3499 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3500 one fails.
3501
3502 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3503 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3504 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3505
3506 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3507 server's queue.
3508
3509 Example of a header received by the application server :
3510 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3511 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3512
3513 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3514
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003515http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3516 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003517 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003518 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003519 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003520 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3521 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003522 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3523 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003524 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3525 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3526 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003527 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003528 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003529 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003530 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003531 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003532 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003533 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003534 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003535 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3536
3537 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3538 no | yes | yes | yes
3539
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003540 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3541 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3542 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3543 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3544 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003545
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003546 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3547 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3548 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3549
3550 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003551 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3552 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3553 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3554 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003555
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003556 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3557 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3558 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3559 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3560 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3561 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3562 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3563 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3564 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003565 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003566 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3567 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003568
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003569 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3570 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3571 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3572 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3573 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3574
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003575 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3576 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3577 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003578 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3579 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003580
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003581 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3582 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3583 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3584 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3585 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3586 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3587 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3588 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3589
3590 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3591 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3592 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003593 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3594 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003595
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003596 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3597 <name>.
3598
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003599 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3600 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3601 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3602 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3603 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3604 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3605 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3606 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3607
3608 Example:
3609
3610 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3611
3612 applied to:
3613
3614 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3615
3616 outputs:
3617
3618 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3619
3620 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3621
3622 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3623 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3624 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3625 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3626 header.
3627
3628 Example:
3629
3630 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3631
3632 applied to:
3633
3634 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3635
3636 outputs:
3637
3638 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3639
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003640 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3641 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3642 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3643 it.
3644
3645 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3646 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3647 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3648 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3649 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3650 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3651
3652 Example :
3653 # prepend the host name before the path
3654 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3655
3656 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3657 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3658 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3659 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3660 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3661 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3662 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3663 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3664
3665 Example :
3666 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3667 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3668
3669 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3670 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3671 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3672 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3673 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3674 "set-query".
3675
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003676 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3677 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3678 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3679 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3680 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3681 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3682 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3683 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3684
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003685 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3686 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3687 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3688 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3689 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3690 another equipment.
3691
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003692 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3693 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3694 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3695 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3696 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3697 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3698 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3699 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3700
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003701 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3702 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3703 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3704 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3705 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3706 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3707 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3708 admin privileges.
3709
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003710 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3711 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3712 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3713 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3714 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3715 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3716 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3717 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3718
3719 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3720 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3721 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3722 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3723 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3724 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3725
3726 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3727 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3728 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3729 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3730 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3731 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3732
3733 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3734 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3735 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3736 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3737 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3738 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3739 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3740 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3741 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3742
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003743 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003744 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3745 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3746 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3747 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3748 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3749 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3750 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3751 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3752 request header" for more information.
3753
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003754 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3755 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3756 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3757 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003758 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3759 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003760
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003761 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3762 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3763 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3764 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3765 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3766 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3767 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3768 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3769 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3770 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3771 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3772 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3773
3774 These actions take one or two arguments :
3775 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3776 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3777 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3778 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3779
3780 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3781 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3782 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3783 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3784
3785 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3786 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3787 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3788 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3789 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3790 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3791 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3792 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3793
3794 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3795 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3796 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3797 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3798 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3799
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003800 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3801 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3802 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3803 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3804 continues.
3805
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003806 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3807 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3808 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3809 the actions evaluation continues.
3810
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003811 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3812 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3813 inline.
3814
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003815 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3816 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3817 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3818 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003819 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003820 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003821 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003822 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3823 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003824 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003825 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003826 and '_'.
3827
3828 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3829 followed by some converters.
3830
3831 Example:
3832
3833 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3834
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003835 - set-src <expr> :
3836 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3837 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3838 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3839 source IP for privacy.
3840
3841 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3842 followed by some converters.
3843
3844 Example:
3845
3846 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3847 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3848
3849 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3850
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003851 - set-src-port <expr> :
3852 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3853 expression.
3854
3855 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3856 followed by some converters.
3857
3858 Example:
3859
3860 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3861 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3862
3863 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
3864 the source port to 0.
3865
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003866 - set-dst <expr> :
3867 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
3868 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
3869 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3870 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3871 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3872
3873 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3874 followed by some converters.
3875
3876 Example:
3877
3878 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
3879 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
3880
3881 - set-dst-port <expr> :
3882 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
3883 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3884 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3885
3886 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3887 followed by some converters.
3888
3889 Example:
3890
3891 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
3892 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
3893
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003894 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3895 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3896 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3897 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3898 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3899 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3900 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3901 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3902 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3903 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3904 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3905 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3906 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3907 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3908 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3909 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3910
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003911 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3912
3913 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3914 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003915 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3916 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3917
3918 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3919 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3920 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3921 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003922
3923 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003924 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3925 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3926 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003927
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003928 http-request allow if nagios
3929 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3930 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3931 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003932
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003933 Example:
3934 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003935 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003936
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003937 Example:
3938 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3939 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003940 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003941 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3942 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3943 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3944 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3945 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3946 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3947
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003948 Example:
3949 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3950 acl add path /addacl
3951 acl del path /delacl
3952
3953 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3954
3955 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3956 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3957
3958 Example:
3959 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3960 acl setmap path /setmap
3961 acl delmap path /delmap
3962
3963 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3964
3965 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3966 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3967
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003968 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3969 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003970
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003971http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003972 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003973 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003974 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3975 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003976 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003977 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3978 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3979 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3980 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003981 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003982 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003983 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003984 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003985 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003986 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003987 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003988 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3989
3990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3991 no | yes | yes | yes
3992
3993 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3994 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3995 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3996 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3997 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3998 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3999
4000 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4001 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4002 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4003 current section.
4004
4005 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4006 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4007 rules are evaluated.
4008
4009 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4010 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4011 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4012 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4013 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4014 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4015 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4016
4017 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4018 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4019 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4020 external users.
4021
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004022 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4023 <name>.
4024
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004025 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4026 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4027 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4028 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4029 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4030 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4031 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4032 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4033
4034 Example:
4035
4036 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4037
4038 applied to:
4039
4040 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4041
4042 outputs:
4043
4044 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4045
4046 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4047
4048 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4049 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4050 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4051 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4052 header.
4053
4054 Example:
4055
4056 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4057
4058 applied to:
4059
4060 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4061
4062 outputs:
4063
4064 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4065
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004066 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4067 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4068 adapted to the new code.
4069
4070 Example:
4071
4072 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4073 http-response set-status 431
4074
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004075 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4076 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4077 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4078 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4079 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4080 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4081 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4082 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4083
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004084 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4085 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4086 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4087 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4088 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4089 another equipment.
4090
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004091 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4092 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4093 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4094 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4095 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4096 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4097 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4098 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4099
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004100 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4101 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4102 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4103 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4104 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4105 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4106 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4107 admin privileges.
4108
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004109 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4110 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4111 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4112 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4113 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4114 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4115 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4116 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4117
4118 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4119 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4120 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4121 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4122 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4123 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4124
4125 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4126 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4127 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4128 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4129 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4130 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4131
4132 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4133 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4134 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4135 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4136 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4137 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4138 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4139 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4140 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4141
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004142 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4143 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4144 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4145 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4146 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4147 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4148 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4149 response header" for more information.
4150
4151 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4152 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4153 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4154 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4155 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004156 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4157 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004158
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004159 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4160 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4161 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4162 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4163 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4164 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4165
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004166 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4167 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4168 inline.
4169
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004170 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4171 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4172 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4173 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004174 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004175 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004176 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004177 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4178 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004179 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004180 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004181 and '_'.
4182
4183 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4184 followed by some converters.
4185
4186 Example:
4187
4188 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4189
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004190 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4191 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4192 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4193 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4194 continues.
4195
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004196 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4197 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4198 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4199 the actions evaluation continues.
4200
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004201 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4202 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4203 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4204 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4205 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4206 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4207 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4208 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4209 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4210 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4211 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4212 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4213 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4214 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4215 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4216 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4217
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004218 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4219
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004220 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004221 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4222 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004223 rules.
4224
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004225 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4226 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4227 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4228 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4229
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004230 Example:
4231 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4232
4233 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4234
4235 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4236 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4237
4238 Example:
4239 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4240
4241 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4242
4243 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4244 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4245
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004246 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4247 ACL usage.
4248
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004249
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004250http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4251 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4252
4253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4254 yes | no | yes | yes
4255
4256 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4257 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4258 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4259 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4260 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4261 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4262
4263 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4264
4265 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4266 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4267 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4268 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4269 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4270 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4271 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4272 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4273 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4274 not checking any request past the first one.
4275
4276 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4277 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4278 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4279 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4280 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4281 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4282 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4283
4284 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4285 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4286 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4287 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4288 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4289 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4290 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4291 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4292 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4293 downsides of rare connection failures.
4294
4295 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4296 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4297 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4298 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4299 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4300 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4301 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4302 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4303 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4304 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4305 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4306 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4307
4308 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4309 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4310 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4311 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4312
4313 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4314 and are never shared ;
4315
4316 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4317 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4318 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4319 and are never shared ;
4320
4321 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4322 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4323 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4324
4325 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4326 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4327 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4328
4329 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4330
4331
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004332http-send-name-header [<header>]
4333 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4334
4335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4336 yes | no | yes | yes
4337
4338 Arguments :
4339
4340 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4341
4342 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4343 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4344 is added with the header string proved.
4345
4346 See also : "server"
4347
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004348id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004349 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4351 no | yes | yes | yes
4352 Arguments : none
4353
4354 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4355 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4356 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004357
4358
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004359ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4360 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4361 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4362 no | yes | yes | yes
4363
4364 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4365 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4366 and running).
4367
4368 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4369 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4370 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004371 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004372 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4373
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004374 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4375 "unless" condition is met.
4376
4377 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4378
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004379load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4380 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4382 yes | no | yes | yes
4383
4384 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4385 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4386 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4387 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4388 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4389 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4390 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4391 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4392
4393 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4394 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004395 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004396
4397 Arguments:
4398 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4399 named "server-state-file".
4400
4401 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4402 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4403 name is used as a file name.
4404
4405 none don't load any stat for this backend
4406
4407 Notes:
4408 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4409 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4410 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4411
4412 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4413 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4414
4415 Example 1:
4416
4417 Minimal configuration:
4418
4419 global
4420 stats socket /tmp/socket
4421 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
4422
4423 defaults
4424 load-server-state-from-file global
4425
4426 backend bk
4427 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4428 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4429
4430 Then one can run :
4431
4432 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4433
4434 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4435
4436 1
4437 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4438 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4439 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4440
4441 Example 2:
4442
4443 Minimal configuration:
4444
4445 global
4446 stats socket /tmp/socket
4447 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4448
4449 defaults
4450 load-server-state-from-file local
4451
4452 backend bk
4453 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4454 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4455
4456 Then one can run :
4457
4458 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4459
4460 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4461
4462 1
4463 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4464 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4465 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4466
4467 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4468 "show servers state"
4469
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004470
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004471log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004472log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004473no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004474 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4476 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004477
4478 Prefix :
4479 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4480 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4481 prefix does not allow arguments.
4482
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004483 Arguments :
4484 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4485 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4486 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4487 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4488 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4489 parameter.
4490
4491 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4492 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4493
4494 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4495 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4496 standard syslog port).
4497
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004498 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4499 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4500 standard syslog port).
4501
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004502 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4503 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4504 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4505 appropriately writeable).
4506
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004507 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4508 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004509
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004510 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4511 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4512 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4513 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4514 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4515 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4516 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4517 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4518 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4519 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4520 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4521
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004522 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4523
4524 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4525 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4526 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4527
4528 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4529 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4530 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004531 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4532 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4533 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4534 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4535 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004536
4537 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4538
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004539 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4540 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4541 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004542
4543 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4544 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4545 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4546 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4547
4548 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4549 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004550
4551 Example :
4552 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004553 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4554 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004555 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004556
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004557
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004558log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004559 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4560 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4561 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004562
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004563 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4564 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4565 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4566 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4567 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004568
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004569log-format-sd <string>
4570 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4572 yes | yes | yes | no
4573
4574 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4575 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4576 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4577 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4578 which covers the log format string in depth.
4579
4580 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4581 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4582
4583 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4584 log format to "rfc5424".
4585
4586 Example :
4587 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4588
4589
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004590log-tag <string>
4591 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4593 yes | yes | yes | yes
4594
4595 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4596 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4597 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4598 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4599 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4600 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4601 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4602 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4603 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004604
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004605max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4606 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4607 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | no | yes | yes
4609
4610 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4611 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4612 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4613 servers.
4614
4615 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4616 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4617 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4618 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4619 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4620 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4621 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4622 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4623 picking a different server.
4624
4625 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4626 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4627 even if they have to be queued.
4628
4629 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4630 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4631
4632
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004633maxconn <conns>
4634 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4636 yes | yes | yes | no
4637 Arguments :
4638 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4639 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4640 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4641 closes.
4642
4643 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4644 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4645 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4646 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004647 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4648 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4649 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4650 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004651
4652 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4653 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4654 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4655
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004656 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4657
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004658 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4659
4660
4661mode { tcp|http|health }
4662 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4664 yes | yes | yes | yes
4665 Arguments :
4666 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4667 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4668 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4669 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4670
4671 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4672 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4673 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4674 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4675 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4676
4677 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004678 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4679 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4680 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4681 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4682 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4683 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4684 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004685
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004686 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4687 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4688 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004689
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004690 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004691 defaults http_instances
4692 mode http
4693
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004694 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004696
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004697monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004698 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4700 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004701 Arguments :
4702 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4703 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004704 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004705 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4706 backend and its backup.
4707
4708 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4709 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4710 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4711 servers in a list of backends.
4712
4713 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4714 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4715 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4716 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4717 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4718 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4719 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004720 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4721 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004722
4723 Example:
4724 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004725 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004726 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4727 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4728 monitor-uri /site_alive
4729 monitor fail if site_dead
4730
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004731 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004732
4733
4734monitor-net <source>
4735 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4737 yes | yes | yes | no
4738 Arguments :
4739 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4740 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4741 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4742 followed by a mask.
4743
4744 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4745 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004746 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004747 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4748
4749 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4750 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4751 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4752 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004753 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4754 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4755 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004756
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004757 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4758 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4759 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4760 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4761 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4762 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004763
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004764 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4765 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004766
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004767 Example :
4768 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4769 frontend www
4770 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4771
4772 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4773
4774
4775monitor-uri <uri>
4776 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4778 yes | yes | yes | no
4779 Arguments :
4780 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4781 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4782
4783 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4784 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4785 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4786 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4787 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4788 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4789 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4790 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4791
4792 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4793 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4794 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4795 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4796 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4797 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4798
4799 Example :
4800 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4801 frontend www
4802 mode http
4803 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4804
4805 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004807
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004808option abortonclose
4809no option abortonclose
4810 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4812 yes | no | yes | yes
4813 Arguments : none
4814
4815 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4816 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4817 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4818 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004819 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004820 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4821 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4822 encountered while delivering the response.
4823
4824 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4825 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4826 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4827 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4828 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4829 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004830 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004831 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004832 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004833 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4834 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4835 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4836
4837 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4838 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4839 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4840 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4841 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4842 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4843 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4844 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004845 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004846
4847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4849
4850 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4851
4852
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004853option accept-invalid-http-request
4854no option accept-invalid-http-request
4855 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4857 yes | yes | yes | no
4858 Arguments : none
4859
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004860 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004861 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4862 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4863 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4864 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4865 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4866 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4867 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004868 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4869 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4870 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4871 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4872 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004873 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004874 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4875 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4876 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004877
4878 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4879 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4880 been confirmed.
4881
4882 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4883 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004884 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4885 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004886 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4887
4888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4890
4891 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4892 stats socket.
4893
4894
4895option accept-invalid-http-response
4896no option accept-invalid-http-response
4897 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4899 yes | no | yes | yes
4900 Arguments : none
4901
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004902 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004903 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4904 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4905 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4906 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4907 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4908 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4909 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004910 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4911 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4912 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004913
4914 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4915 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4916 been confirmed.
4917
4918 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4919 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4920 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4921 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4922
4923 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4924 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4925
4926 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4927 stats socket.
4928
4929
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004930option allbackups
4931no option allbackups
4932 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | no | yes | yes
4935 Arguments : none
4936
4937 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4938 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4939 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4940 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4941 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4942 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4943 order between the backup servers anymore.
4944
4945 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4946 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4947
4948 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4949 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4950
4951
4952option checkcache
4953no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004954 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4956 yes | no | yes | yes
4957 Arguments : none
4958
4959 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4960 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004961 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004962 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4963 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004964 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004965
4966 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004967 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004968 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004969 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4970 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004971 to the client are :
4972 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004973 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004974 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004975 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4976 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4977 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4978 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4979 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4980 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4981 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4982 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4983 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4984 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4985 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4986
4987 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004988 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004989 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004990 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004991 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4992
4993 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4994 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004995 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004996 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4997
4998 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4999 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5000
5001
5002option clitcpka
5003no option clitcpka
5004 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 yes | yes | yes | no
5007 Arguments : none
5008
5009 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5010 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5011 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5012 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5013
5014 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5015 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5016 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5017 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5018
5019 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5020 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5021 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5022 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5023 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5024
5025 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5026
5027 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5028 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5029 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5030
5031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5033
5034 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5035
5036
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005037option contstats
5038 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5040 yes | yes | yes | no
5041 Arguments : none
5042
5043 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5044 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5045 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5046 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
5047 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
5048 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
5049 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
5050
5051
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005052option dontlog-normal
5053no option dontlog-normal
5054 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5056 yes | yes | yes | no
5057 Arguments : none
5058
5059 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5060 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5061 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5062 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5063 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5064 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5065 logged.
5066
5067 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5068 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5069 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005071 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005072 logging.
5073
5074
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005075option dontlognull
5076no option dontlognull
5077 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 yes | yes | yes | no
5080 Arguments : none
5081
5082 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5083 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5084 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5085 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5086 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5087 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005088 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5089 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5090 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005091
5092 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5093 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5094 would not be logged.
5095
5096 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5097 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5098
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005099 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5100 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005101
5102
5103option forceclose
5104no option forceclose
5105 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005107 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005108 Arguments : none
5109
5110 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5111 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5112 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5113 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5114 global session times in the logs.
5115
5116 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005117 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005118 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005119
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005120 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5121 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5122 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5123
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005124 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5125 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005126
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5129
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005130 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005131
5132
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005133option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005134 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 yes | yes | yes | yes
5137 Arguments :
5138 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5139 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005140 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005141 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005142
5143 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5144 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5145 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5146 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5147 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5148 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5149 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005150 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5151 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5152 possible that the client has already brought one.
5153
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005154 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005155 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005156 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5157 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005158 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5159 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005160
5161 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5162 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5163 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5164 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5165 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5166 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5167 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5168
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005169 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5170 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5171 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5172 are under the control of the end-user.
5173
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005174 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005175 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5176 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005177 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5178 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5179 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005180
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005181 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005182 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5183 frontend www
5184 mode http
5185 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5186
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005187 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5188 backend www
5189 mode http
5190 option forwardfor header X-Client
5191
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005192 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005193 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005194
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005195
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005196option http-buffer-request
5197no option http-buffer-request
5198 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5200 yes | yes | yes | yes
5201 Arguments : none
5202
5203 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5204 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5205 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5206 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5207 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5208 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5209 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5210 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5211 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5212 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5213 default.
5214
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005215 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005216
5217
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005218option http-ignore-probes
5219no option http-ignore-probes
5220 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5222 yes | yes | yes | no
5223 Arguments : none
5224
5225 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5226 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5227 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5228 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5229 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5230 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5231 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5232 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5233 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5234 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5235 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5236 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5237
5238 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5239 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5240 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5241 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5242 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5243 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5244 are often the only way to detect them.
5245
5246 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5247 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5248
5249 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5250
5251
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005252option http-keep-alive
5253no option http-keep-alive
5254 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5256 yes | yes | yes | yes
5257 Arguments : none
5258
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005259 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5260 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5261 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5262 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5263 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5264 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5265 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5266
5267 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5268 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005269 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5270 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5271 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5272 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5273 situations where this option may be useful :
5274
5275 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5276 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5277
5278 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5279 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5280
5281 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5282 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5283 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5284 request.
5285
5286 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5287 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005288 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5289 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5290 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005291
5292 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5293 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5294
5295 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5296 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5297 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5298 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5299 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5300 not set.
5301
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005302 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5303 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005304 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005305 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005306
5307 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005308 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5309 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005310
5311
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005312option http-no-delay
5313no option http-no-delay
5314 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5316 yes | yes | yes | yes
5317 Arguments : none
5318
5319 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5320 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5321 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5322 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5323 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5324 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5325 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5326 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5327 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5328 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5329 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5330 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5331 affected.
5332
5333 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5334 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5335 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5336 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5337 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5338 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5339 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5340 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5341 latency environments.
5342
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005343 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5344
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005345
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005346option http-pretend-keepalive
5347no option http-pretend-keepalive
5348 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5350 yes | yes | yes | yes
5351 Arguments : none
5352
5353 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5354 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5355 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5356 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5357 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5358 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5359 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5360 consider the response complete.
5361
5362 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5363 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5364 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5365 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5366 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5367 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5368
5369 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5370 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5371 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5372 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5373 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5374 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5375 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5376
5377 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5378 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005379 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005380 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5381 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005382
5383 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5384 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5385
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005386 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5387 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005388
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005389
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005390option http-server-close
5391no option http-server-close
5392 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5394 yes | yes | yes | yes
5395 Arguments : none
5396
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005397 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5398 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5399 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5400 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5401 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5402 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5403 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5404 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5405 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5406 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5407 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5408 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5409 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5410 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5411 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5412 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005413
5414 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5415 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5416 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5417 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005418 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5419 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005420
5421 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5422 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005423 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5424 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005425 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5426 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005427
5428 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5429 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5430
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005431 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005432 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5433 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005434
5435
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005436option http-tunnel
5437no option http-tunnel
5438 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5440 yes | yes | yes | yes
5441 Arguments : none
5442
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005443 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5444 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5445 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5446 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5447 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5448 "option http-tunnel".
5449
5450 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005451 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005452 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5453 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5454 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5455 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5456 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5457 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5458 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005459
5460 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5461 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5462
5463 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5464 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5465 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5466
5467
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005468option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005469no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005470 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5472 yes | yes | yes | no
5473 Arguments : none
5474
5475 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5476 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5477 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5478 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5479 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5480 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5481 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5482
5483 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5484 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005485 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5486 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5487 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005488
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005489 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5490 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5491 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5492 front of an existing proxy.
5493
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005494 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5495
5496 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5497 http-server-close".
5498
5499
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005500option httpchk
5501option httpchk <uri>
5502option httpchk <method> <uri>
5503option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5504 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5506 yes | no | yes | yes
5507 Arguments :
5508 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5509 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5510 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5511 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5512 ones.
5513
5514 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5515 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5516 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5517
5518 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5519 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5520 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5521 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5522 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5523
5524 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5525 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5526 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5527 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5528 the lack of any response.
5529
5530 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5531
5532 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5533 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5534 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5535
5536 Examples :
5537 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5538 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5539 backend https_relay
5540 mode tcp
5541 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5542 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5543
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005544 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5545 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5546 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005547
5548
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005549option httpclose
5550no option httpclose
5551 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5553 yes | yes | yes | yes
5554 Arguments : none
5555
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005556 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5557 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5558 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5559 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005560 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005561 "option http-tunnel".
5562
5563 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5564 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5565 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5566 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5567 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5568 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5569 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5570 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005571
5572 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005573 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005574 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5575 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5576 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5577 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5578 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005579
5580 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5581 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005582 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5583 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005584 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5585 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005586
5587 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5588 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5589
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005590 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5591 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005592
5593
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005594option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005595 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5597 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005598 Arguments :
5599 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5600 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5601 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5602 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5603 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005604
5605 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5606 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5607 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5608 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5609 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5610 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5611 ports.
5612
5613 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5614
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005615 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5616 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005618 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005619
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005620
5621option http_proxy
5622no option http_proxy
5623 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5625 yes | yes | yes | yes
5626 Arguments : none
5627
5628 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5629 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5630 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5631 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5632 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5633
5634 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5635 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005636 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5637 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005638
5639 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5640 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5641
5642 Example :
5643 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5644 backend direct_forward
5645 option httpclose
5646 option http_proxy
5647
5648 See also : "option httpclose"
5649
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005650
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005651option independent-streams
5652no option independent-streams
5653 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5655 yes | yes | yes | yes
5656 Arguments : none
5657
5658 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5659 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5660 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5661 receive data or not.
5662
5663 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5664 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5665 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5666 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5667 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5668 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5669 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5670 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5671 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5672 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5673 socket buffers.
5674
5675 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5676 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5677 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5678 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5679 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5680
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005681 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005682 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5683 deprecated.
5684
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005685 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005686
5687
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005688option ldap-check
5689 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5691 yes | no | yes | yes
5692 Arguments : none
5693
5694 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5695 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5696 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5697 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5698
5699 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5700 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5701
5702 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5703 configure it.
5704
5705 Example :
5706 option ldap-check
5707
5708 See also : "option httpchk"
5709
5710
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005711option external-check
5712 Use external processes for server health checks
5713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5714 yes | no | yes | yes
5715
5716 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5717 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5718 command".
5719
5720 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5721
5722 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5723
5724
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005725option log-health-checks
5726no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005727 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5729 yes | no | yes | yes
5730 Arguments : none
5731
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005732 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5733 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5734 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005735
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005736 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5737 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5738 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5739 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5740 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5741
5742 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5743 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005744
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005745 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5746 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5747 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005748
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005749
5750option log-separate-errors
5751no option log-separate-errors
5752 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5754 yes | yes | yes | no
5755 Arguments : none
5756
5757 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5758 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5759 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5760 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5761 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5762 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5763 provides very important information.
5764
5765 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5766 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5767 error logs.
5768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005769 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005770 logging.
5771
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005772
5773option logasap
5774no option logasap
5775 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5777 yes | yes | yes | no
5778 Arguments : none
5779
5780 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5781 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5782 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5783 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5784 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5785 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5786 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005787 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005788 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5789 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5790
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005791 Examples :
5792 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5793 mode http
5794 option httplog
5795 option logasap
5796 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5797
5798 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5799 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5800 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5801 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005803 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005804 logging.
5805
5806
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005807option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005808 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005811 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005812 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5813 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005814 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005815
5816 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5817 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5818 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5819 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5820 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5821 in the MySQL table, like this :
5822
5823 USE mysql;
5824 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5825 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5826
5827 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5828 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5829 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5830 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5831 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5832 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5833 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5834 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5835 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5836
5837 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5838 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005839
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005840 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005841
5842 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5843 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5844 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5845 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005846 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5847 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005848
5849 See also: "option httpchk"
5850
5851
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005852option nolinger
5853no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005854 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5856 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005857 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005858
5859 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5860 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5861 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5862 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5863 connections.
5864
5865 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5866 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5867 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5868 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5869 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5870 this too.
5871
5872 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5873 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5874 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5875
5876 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5877 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5878 for servers.
5879
5880 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5881 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5882
5883
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005884option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5885 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5887 yes | yes | yes | yes
5888 Arguments :
5889 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5890 matching <network>
5891 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5892 header name.
5893
5894 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5895 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5896 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5897 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5898 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5899 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5900 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5901 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5902 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5903 possible that the client has already brought one.
5904
5905 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5906 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5907 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5908 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5909 header and requires different one.
5910
5911 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5912 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5913 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5914 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5915 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5916 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5917 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5918
5919 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5920 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5921 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5922 both are defined.
5923
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005924 Examples :
5925 # Original Destination address
5926 frontend www
5927 mode http
5928 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5929
5930 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5931 backend www
5932 mode http
5933 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5934
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005935 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5936 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005937
5938
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005939option persist
5940no option persist
5941 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5942 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5943 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005944 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005945
5946 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5947 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5948 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5949 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5950 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5951 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5952 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5953 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5954 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5955 redirected to another valid server.
5956
5957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5959
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005960 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005961
5962
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005963option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5964 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5966 yes | no | yes | yes
5967 Arguments :
5968 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5969 PostgreSQL server.
5970
5971 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5972 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5973 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5974 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5975
5976 See also: "option httpchk"
5977
5978
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005979option prefer-last-server
5980no option prefer-last-server
5981 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5983 yes | no | yes | yes
5984 Arguments : none
5985
5986 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5987 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5988 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5989 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5990 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5991 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5992 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5993 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5994 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005995 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5996 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5997 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5998 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5999 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6000 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6001 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006002
6003 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6004 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6005
6006 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6007
6008
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006009option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006010option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006011no option redispatch
6012 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6013 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6014 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006015 Arguments :
6016 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6017 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6018 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6019 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6020 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6021 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6022 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6023 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6024 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006026
6027 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6028 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6029 be able to access the service anymore.
6030
6031 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6032 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6033
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006034 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006035 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6036 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006038 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6039 "redisp" keywords.
6040
6041 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6042 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6043
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006044 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006045
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006046
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006047option redis-check
6048 Use redis health checks for server testing
6049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6050 yes | no | yes | yes
6051 Arguments : none
6052
6053 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6054 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6055 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6056 find the "+PONG" response message.
6057
6058 Example :
6059 option redis-check
6060
6061 See also : "option httpchk"
6062
6063
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006064option smtpchk
6065option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6066 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6068 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006069 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006070 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6071 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6072 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6073
6074 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6075 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6076 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6077
6078 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6079 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6080 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6081 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6082 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6083 dead server.
6084
6085 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6086 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6087 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6088 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6089
6090 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6091 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6092 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6093 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006094 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006095
6096 Example :
6097 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6098
6099 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006102option socket-stats
6103no option socket-stats
6104
6105 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6107 yes | yes | yes | no
6108
6109 Arguments : none
6110
6111
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006112option splice-auto
6113no option splice-auto
6114 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6116 yes | yes | yes | yes
6117 Arguments : none
6118
6119 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6120 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6121 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6122 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006123 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006124 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6125 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6126 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6127 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6128
6129 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6130 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6131 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6132 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6133 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6134 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6135 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6136 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6137 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6138 keyword.
6139
6140 Example :
6141 option splice-auto
6142
6143 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6144 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6145
6146 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6147 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6148
6149
6150option splice-request
6151no option splice-request
6152 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6154 yes | yes | yes | yes
6155 Arguments : none
6156
6157 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006158 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006159 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6160 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6161 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6162 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6163
6164 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6165
6166 Example :
6167 option splice-request
6168
6169 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6170 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6171
6172 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6173 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6174
6175
6176option splice-response
6177no option splice-response
6178 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6180 yes | yes | yes | yes
6181 Arguments : none
6182
6183 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006184 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006185 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6186 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6187 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6188 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6189
6190 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6191
6192 Example :
6193 option splice-response
6194
6195 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6196 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6197
6198 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6199 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6200
6201
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006202option srvtcpka
6203no option srvtcpka
6204 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6206 yes | no | yes | yes
6207 Arguments : none
6208
6209 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6210 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6211 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6212 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6213
6214 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6215 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6216 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6217 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6218
6219 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6220 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6221 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6222 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6223 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6224
6225 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6226
6227 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6228 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6229 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6230
6231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6233
6234 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6235
6236
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006237option ssl-hello-chk
6238 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6240 yes | no | yes | yes
6241 Arguments : none
6242
6243 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6244 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6245 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6246 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6247 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6248 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6249 hello message.
6250
6251 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6252 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6253 messages, which is appreciable.
6254
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006255 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6256 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6257 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006258
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006259 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6260
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006261
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006262option tcp-check
6263 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6264 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6265 yes | no | yes | yes
6266
6267 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6268 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6269
6270 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6271 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6272 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6273
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006274 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006275 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6276 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6277 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6278 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6279 only.
6280
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006281 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006282 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6283 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6284 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6285 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6286
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006287 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006288 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6289 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006290 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006291 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6292 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6293 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6294 the respective protocols.
6295 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6296 analysed.
6297
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006298 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6299 script.
6300
6301 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6302 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6303 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6304 The "comment" is of course optional.
6305
6306
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006307 Examples :
6308 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6309 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006310 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006311
6312 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6313 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006314 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006315
6316 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6317 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006318 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006319 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006320 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006321 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006322 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006323 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006324 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6325 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006326 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006327 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6328 tcp-check expect string +OK
6329
6330 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6331 (send many headers before analyzing)
6332 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006333 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006334 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6335 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6336 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6337 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006338 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006339
6340
6341 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6342
6343
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006344option tcp-smart-accept
6345no option tcp-smart-accept
6346 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6348 yes | yes | yes | no
6349 Arguments : none
6350
6351 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6352 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6353 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6354 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6355 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6356 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6357
6358 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6359 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6360 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6361 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6362
6363 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6364 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6365 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6366 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6367
6368 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6369 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6370 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6371
6372 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6373 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6374 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6375
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006376 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6377
6378
6379option tcp-smart-connect
6380no option tcp-smart-connect
6381 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6383 yes | no | yes | yes
6384 Arguments : none
6385
6386 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6387 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6388 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6389 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6390 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6391
6392 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6393 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6394 complex.
6395
6396 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6397 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6398 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6399
6400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6402
6403 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6404
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006405
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006406option tcpka
6407 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6409 yes | yes | yes | yes
6410 Arguments : none
6411
6412 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6413 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6414 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6415 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6416
6417 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6418 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6419 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6420 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6421
6422 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6423 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6424 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6425 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6426 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6427
6428 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6429
6430 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6431 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6432 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6433 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6434 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6435 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6436 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6437 backends.
6438
6439 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6440
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006441
6442option tcplog
6443 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6445 yes | yes | yes | yes
6446 Arguments : none
6447
6448 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6449 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6450 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6451 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6452 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6453 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6454 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6455 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6456
6457 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006459 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006460
6461
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006462option transparent
6463no option transparent
6464 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006466 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006467 Arguments : none
6468
6469 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6470 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6471 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6472 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6473 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6474 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6475 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6476 appropriate server.
6477
6478 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6479 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6480
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006481 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006482 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006483
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006484
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006485external-check command <command>
6486 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6488 yes | no | yes | yes
6489
6490 Arguments :
6491 <command> is the external command to run
6492
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006493 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6494
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006495 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006496
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006497 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6498 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6499 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6500 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6501 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6502 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006503
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006504 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6505
6506 Environment variables :
6507 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6508 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6509
6510 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6511
6512 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6513
6514 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6515 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6516 for a UNIX socket).
6517
6518 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6519
6520 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6521
6522 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6523
6524 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6525
6526 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6527
6528 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6529 socket).
6530
6531 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6532 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6533
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006534 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6535 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6536 failed.
6537
6538 Example :
6539 external-check command /bin/true
6540
6541 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6542
6543
6544external-check path <path>
6545 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6547 yes | no | yes | yes
6548
6549 Arguments :
6550 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6551
6552 The default path is "".
6553
6554 Example :
6555 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6556
6557 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6558 "external-check command"
6559
6560
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006561persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006562persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006563 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6565 yes | no | yes | yes
6566 Arguments :
6567 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006568 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6569 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006570
6571 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6572 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6573 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6574 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6575 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6576 forwarded to this server.
6577
6578 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6579 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6580 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006581 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006582 a single "listen" section.
6583
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006584 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6585 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6586 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6587
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006588 Example :
6589 listen tse-farm
6590 bind :3389
6591 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6592 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6593 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6594 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6595 persist rdp-cookie
6596 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006597 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006598 balance rdp-cookie
6599 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6600 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6601
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006602 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6603 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006604
6605
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006606rate-limit sessions <rate>
6607 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6609 yes | yes | yes | no
6610 Arguments :
6611 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6612 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6613
6614 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6615 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6616 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6617 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6618 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6619 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6620
6621 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6622 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6623 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6624 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6625
6626 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6627 listen smtp
6628 mode tcp
6629 bind :25
6630 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006631 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006632
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006633 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6634 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6635 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006636
6637 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6638
6639
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006640redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6641redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6642redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006643 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6645 no | yes | yes | yes
6646
6647 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006648 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006649
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006650 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006651 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006652 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6653 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6654 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006655
6656 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6657 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6658 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6659 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6660 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006661 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6662 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6663 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6664 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006665
6666 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6667 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6668 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6669 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6670 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6671 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006672 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006673 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006674 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6675 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6676 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006677
6678 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006679 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6680 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6681 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006682 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006683 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6684 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6685 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6686 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006687
6688 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6689 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6690
6691 - "drop-query"
6692 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6693 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6694 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6695 with a location-type redirect.
6696
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006697 - "append-slash"
6698 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6699 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6700 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6701 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6702
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006703 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6704 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6705 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6706 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6707 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6708 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6709 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6710
6711 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6712 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6713 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6714 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6715 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6716 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6717 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006718
6719 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6720 acl clear dst_port 80
6721 acl secure dst_port 8080
6722 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006723 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006724 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006725 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6726
6727 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006728 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6729 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6730 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006731 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006732
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006733 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6734 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6735 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6736
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006737 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006738 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006739
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006740 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006741 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6742 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6743 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006745 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006746
6747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006748redisp (deprecated)
6749redispatch (deprecated)
6750 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006753 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006754
6755 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6756 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6757 be able to access the service anymore.
6758
6759 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6760 redistribute them to a working server.
6761
6762 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6763 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6764 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006766 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6767 "option redispatch" instead.
6768
6769 See also : "option redispatch"
6770
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006771
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006772reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006773 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6775 no | yes | yes | yes
6776 Arguments :
6777 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6778 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006779 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006780
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006781 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6782 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6783
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006784 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6785 the last header of an HTTP request.
6786
6787 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6788 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6789 responses.
6790
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006791 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6792 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6793 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6794
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006795 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6796 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006797
6798
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006799reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6800reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006801 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6803 no | yes | yes | yes
6804 Arguments :
6805 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6806 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6807 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6808 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6809 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6810 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6811 ignores case.
6812
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006813 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6814 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6815
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006816 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6817 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6818 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6819 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006820 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006821
6822 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6823 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6824
6825 Example :
6826 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6827 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6828 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6829
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006830 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6831 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006832
6833
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006834reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6835reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006836 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6838 no | yes | yes | yes
6839 Arguments :
6840 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6841 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6842 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6843 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6844 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6845 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6846
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006847 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6848 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6849
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006850 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6851 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6852 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6853 next servers.
6854
6855 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6856 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6857 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6858
6859 Example :
6860 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6861 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6862 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6863
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006864 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6865 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006866
6867
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006868reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6869reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006870 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6872 no | yes | yes | yes
6873 Arguments :
6874 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6875 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6876 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6877 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6878 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6879 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6880 case.
6881
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006882 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6883 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6884
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006885 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6886 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6887 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6888 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006889 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006890
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006891 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006892 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006893 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006894
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006895 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6896 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6897
6898 Example :
6899 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6900 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6901 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6902
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006903 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6904 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006905
6906
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006907reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6908reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006909 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6911 no | yes | yes | yes
6912 Arguments :
6913 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6914 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6915 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6916 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6917 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6918 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6919 case.
6920
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006921 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6922 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6923
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006924 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6925 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6926 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6927 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6928
6929 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6930 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6931
6932 Example :
6933 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6934 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6935 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6936 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6937
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006938 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6939 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006940
6941
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006942reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6943reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006944 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6946 no | yes | yes | yes
6947 Arguments :
6948 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6949 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6950 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6951 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6952 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6953 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6954
6955 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6956 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6957 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6958 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006959 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006960
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006961 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6962 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6963
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006964 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6965 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6966 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6967
6968 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6969 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6970 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6971 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6972 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6973
6974 Example :
6975 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006976 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006977 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6978 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6979
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006980 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
6981 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006982
6983
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006984reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6985reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006986 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6988 no | yes | yes | yes
6989 Arguments :
6990 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6991 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6992 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6993 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6994 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6995 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6996 ignores case.
6997
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006998 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6999 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7000
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007001 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7002 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007003 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7004 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7005 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007006 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7007 not set.
7008
7009 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7010 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7011 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7012 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7013 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7014
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007015 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007016 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7017 # block all others.
7018 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7019 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7020
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007021 # block bad guys
7022 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7023 reqitarpit . if badguys
7024
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007025 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7026 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007027
7028
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007029retries <value>
7030 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7032 yes | no | yes | yes
7033 Arguments :
7034 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7035 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7036 default value is 3.
7037
7038 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7039 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7040 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7041
7042 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007043 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7044 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007045
7046 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7047 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7048
7049 See also : "option redispatch"
7050
7051
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007052rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007053 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7055 no | yes | yes | yes
7056 Arguments :
7057 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7058 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007059 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007060
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007061 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7062 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7063
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007064 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7065 the last header of an HTTP response.
7066
7067 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7068 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7069 responses.
7070
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007071 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7072 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007073
7074
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007075rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7076rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007077 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7079 no | yes | yes | yes
7080 Arguments :
7081 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7082 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7083 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7084 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7085 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7086 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7087 ignores case.
7088
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007089 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7090 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7091
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007092 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7093 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007094 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007095 client.
7096
7097 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7098 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7099 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7100
7101 Example :
7102 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007103 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007104
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007105 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7106 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007107
7108
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007109rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7110rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007111 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7113 no | yes | yes | yes
7114 Arguments :
7115 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7116 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7117 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7118 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7119 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7120 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7121 ignores case.
7122
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007123 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7124 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7125
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007126 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7127 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7128 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7129 case-sensitive.
7130
7131 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007132 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7133 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7134 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007135
7136 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7137 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7138
7139 Example :
7140 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7141 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7142
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007143 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7144 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007145
7146
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007147rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7148rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007149 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7151 no | yes | yes | yes
7152 Arguments :
7153 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7154 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7155 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7156 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7157 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7158 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7159 ignores case.
7160
7161 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7162 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7163 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7164 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007165 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007166
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007167 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7168 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7169
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007170 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7171 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7172 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7173
7174 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7175 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7176 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7177 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7178 are not case-sensitive.
7179
7180 Example :
7181 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7182 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7183
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007184 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7185 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007186
7187
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007188server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007189 Declare a server in a backend
7190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7191 no | no | yes | yes
7192 Arguments :
7193 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007194 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007195 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007196
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007197 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7198 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7199 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7200 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007201 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7202 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7203 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7204 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7205 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007206 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7207 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7208 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7209 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7210 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7211 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7212 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007213 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007214 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7215 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7216 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007217
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007218 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007219 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7220 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7221 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7222 adding this value to the client's port.
7223
7224 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7225 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007226 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007227
7228 Examples :
7229 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7230 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007231 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007232 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7233 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7234 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007235
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007236 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7237 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7238 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7239 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7240 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7241
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007242 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7243 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007244
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007245server-state-file-name [<file>]
7246 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7247 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7248 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7249 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7250 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7251 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7252
7253 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7254 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7255
7256 global
7257 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7258
7259 backend bk
7260 load-server-state-from-file
7261
7262 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7263 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007264
7265source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007266source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007267source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007268 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | no | yes | yes
7271 Arguments :
7272 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7273 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007274
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007275 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007276 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7277 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7278 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7279 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7280 supported prefixes are :
7281 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7282 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7283 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007284 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007285 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7286 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007287
7288 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7289 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007290 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7291 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7292 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007293
7294 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7295 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7296 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7297 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7298 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7299 <addr>.
7300
7301 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7302 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7303 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7304 port.
7305
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007306 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7307 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7308 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7309 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007310 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007311 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7312 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7313 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7314 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7315 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7316 HTTP header.
7317
7318 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7319 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007320 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007321 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7322 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7323 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7324 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7325 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7326 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7327 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7328
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007329 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7330 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7331 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7332 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7333 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7334 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7335
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007336 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7337 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7338 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7339 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7340
7341 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7342 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7343 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7344 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7345 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7346 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7347
7348 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7349 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7350 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7351 there are two methods :
7352
7353 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7354 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7355 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7356 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7357 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7358 of the client ranges may be used.
7359
7360 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7361 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7362 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7363 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7364 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7365 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7366 same session.
7367
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007368 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7369 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7370 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007371 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007372
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007373 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7374
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007375 Examples :
7376 backend private
7377 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7378 source 192.168.1.200
7379
7380 backend transparent_ssl1
7381 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7382 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7383
7384 backend transparent_ssl2
7385 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7386 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7387 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7388
7389 backend transparent_ssl3
7390 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7391 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7392 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7393
7394 backend transparent_smtp
7395 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7396 # with Tproxy version 4.
7397 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7398
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007399 backend transparent_http
7400 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7401 # proxy.
7402 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007404 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007405 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007407
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007408srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7409 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7411 yes | no | yes | yes
7412 Arguments :
7413 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7414 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7415 as explained at the top of this document.
7416
7417 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7418 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7419 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7420 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7421 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7422 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7423 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7424
7425 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7426 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7427 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7428 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7429 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007430 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007431 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007432 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007433
7434 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7435 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7436 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7437 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7438 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7439 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7440
7441 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7442 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7443
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007444 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7445 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007446
7447
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007448stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7449 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007451 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007452
7453 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7454 matched.
7455
7456 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7457 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7458
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007459 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7460 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7461 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7462
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007463 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7464 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7465 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7466 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007467
7468 Example :
7469 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7470 backend stats_localhost
7471 stats enable
7472 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7473
7474 Example :
7475 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7476 backend stats_auth
7477 stats enable
7478 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7479 stats admin if TRUE
7480
7481 Example :
7482 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7483 userlist stats-auth
7484 group admin users admin
7485 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7486 group readonly users haproxy
7487 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7488
7489 backend stats_auth
7490 stats enable
7491 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7492 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7493 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7494 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7495
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007496 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7497 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7498 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007499
7500
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007501stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7502 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007504 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007505 Arguments :
7506 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7507
7508 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7509
7510 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7511 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7512 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7513 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7514 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7515 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7516
7517 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7518 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7519 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007520 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007521
7522 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7523 report using "stats scope".
7524
7525 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7526 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7527 unobvious parameters.
7528
7529 Example :
7530 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7531 backend public_www
7532 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7533 stats enable
7534 stats hide-version
7535 stats scope .
7536 stats uri /admin?stats
7537 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7538 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7539 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7540
7541 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7542 backend private_monitoring
7543 stats enable
7544 stats uri /admin?stats
7545 stats refresh 5s
7546
7547 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7548
7549
7550stats enable
7551 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007553 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007554 Arguments : none
7555
7556 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7557 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7558 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7559 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7560 - stats auth : no authentication
7561 - stats scope : no restriction
7562
7563 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7564 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7565 unobvious parameters.
7566
7567 Example :
7568 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7569 backend public_www
7570 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7571 stats enable
7572 stats hide-version
7573 stats scope .
7574 stats uri /admin?stats
7575 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7576 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7577 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7578
7579 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7580 backend private_monitoring
7581 stats enable
7582 stats uri /admin?stats
7583 stats refresh 5s
7584
7585 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7586
7587
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007588stats hide-version
7589 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007591 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007592 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007593
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007594 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7595 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7596 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7597 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7598 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7599 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007601 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7602 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7603 unobvious parameters.
7604
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007605 Example :
7606 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7607 backend public_www
7608 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007609 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007610 stats hide-version
7611 stats scope .
7612 stats uri /admin?stats
7613 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7614 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7615 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007616
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007617 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7618 backend private_monitoring
7619 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007620 stats uri /admin?stats
7621 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007622
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007623 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007624
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007625
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007626stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7627 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7628 Access control for statistics
7629
7630 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7631 no | no | yes | yes
7632
7633 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7634 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7635 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7636 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7637 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7638 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7639
7640 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7641 instance.
7642
7643 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7644 about ACL usage.
7645
7646
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007647stats realm <realm>
7648 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007650 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007651 Arguments :
7652 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7653 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7654 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7655
7656 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7657 using a backslash ('\').
7658
7659 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7660 only related to authentication.
7661
7662 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7663 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7664 unobvious parameters.
7665
7666 Example :
7667 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7668 backend public_www
7669 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7670 stats enable
7671 stats hide-version
7672 stats scope .
7673 stats uri /admin?stats
7674 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7675 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7676 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7677
7678 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7679 backend private_monitoring
7680 stats enable
7681 stats uri /admin?stats
7682 stats refresh 5s
7683
7684 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7685
7686
7687stats refresh <delay>
7688 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007690 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007691 Arguments :
7692 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7693 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7694 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7695 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7696 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7697 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7698
7699 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7700 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7701 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7702 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7703
7704 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7705 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7706 unobvious parameters.
7707
7708 Example :
7709 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7710 backend public_www
7711 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7712 stats enable
7713 stats hide-version
7714 stats scope .
7715 stats uri /admin?stats
7716 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7717 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7718 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7719
7720 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7721 backend private_monitoring
7722 stats enable
7723 stats uri /admin?stats
7724 stats refresh 5s
7725
7726 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7727
7728
7729stats scope { <name> | "." }
7730 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007732 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007733 Arguments :
7734 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7735 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7736 section in which the statement appears.
7737
7738 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7739 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7740 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7741 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7742 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7743 exists.
7744
7745 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7746 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7747 unobvious parameters.
7748
7749 Example :
7750 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7751 backend public_www
7752 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7753 stats enable
7754 stats hide-version
7755 stats scope .
7756 stats uri /admin?stats
7757 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7758 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7759 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7760
7761 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7762 backend private_monitoring
7763 stats enable
7764 stats uri /admin?stats
7765 stats refresh 5s
7766
7767 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7768
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007769
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007770stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007771 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007773 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007774
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007775 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007776 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7777
7778 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7779 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7780
7781 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7782 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007783 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007784
7785 Example :
7786 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7787 backend private_monitoring
7788 stats enable
7789 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7790 stats uri /admin?stats
7791 stats refresh 5s
7792
7793 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7794 global section.
7795
7796
7797stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007798 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7800 yes | yes | yes | yes
7801 Arguments : none
7802
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007803 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007804 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7805 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7806 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7807 - IP (socket, server)
7808 - cookie (backend, server)
7809
7810 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7811 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007812 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007813
7814 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7815
7816
7817stats show-node [ <name> ]
7818 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007820 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007821 Arguments:
7822 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7823 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7824
7825 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7826 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007827 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007828
7829 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7830 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7831 unobvious parameters.
7832
7833 Example:
7834 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7835 backend private_monitoring
7836 stats enable
7837 stats show-node Europe-1
7838 stats uri /admin?stats
7839 stats refresh 5s
7840
7841 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7842 section.
7843
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007844
7845stats uri <prefix>
7846 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007848 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007849 Arguments :
7850 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7851 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7852 query string.
7853
7854 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7855 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7856 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7857 possible to reach it in the application.
7858
7859 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007860 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007861 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7862 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7863 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7864 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7865
7866 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7867 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7868 an address or a port to statistics only.
7869
7870 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7871 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7872 unobvious parameters.
7873
7874 Example :
7875 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7876 backend public_www
7877 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7878 stats enable
7879 stats hide-version
7880 stats scope .
7881 stats uri /admin?stats
7882 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7883 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7884 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7885
7886 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7887 backend private_monitoring
7888 stats enable
7889 stats uri /admin?stats
7890 stats refresh 5s
7891
7892 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7893
7894
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007895stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7896 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007898 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007899
7900 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007901 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007902 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7903 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7904 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7905
7906 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7907 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7908 the "stick-table" statement.
7909
7910 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7911 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7912 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7913 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7914 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7915
7916 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7917 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7918 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7919 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7920 transformation rules.
7921
7922 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7923 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7924 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7925 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7926 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7927 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7928 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7929
7930 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7931 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7932 ACL based conditions.
7933
7934 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7935 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7936 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7937 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7938
7939 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7940 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7941 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7942 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7943
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007944 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7945 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7946 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7947
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007948 Example :
7949 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7950 # last 30 minutes
7951 backend pop
7952 mode tcp
7953 balance roundrobin
7954 stick store-request src
7955 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7956 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7957 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7958
7959 backend smtp
7960 mode tcp
7961 balance roundrobin
7962 stick match src table pop
7963 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7964 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7965
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007966 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007967 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007968
7969
7970stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7971 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7973 no | no | yes | yes
7974
7975 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7976 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7977 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7978 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7979
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007980 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7981 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7982 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7983
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007984 Examples :
7985 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007986 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007987
7988 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7989 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7990 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7991
7992
7993 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7994 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7995 backend http
7996 mode http
7997 balance roundrobin
7998 stick on src table https
7999 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8000 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8001 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8002
8003 backend https
8004 mode tcp
8005 balance roundrobin
8006 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8007 stick on src
8008 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8009 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8010
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008011 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008012
8013
8014stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8015 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8017 no | no | yes | yes
8018
8019 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008020 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008021 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8022 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8023 server is selected.
8024
8025 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8026 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8027 the "stick-table" statement.
8028
8029 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8030 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8031 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8032 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8033 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8034 address.
8035
8036 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8037 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8038 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8039 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8040 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8041 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8042 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8043 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8044 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8045 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8046
8047 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8048 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8049 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8050 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8051 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8052 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8053 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8054
8055 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8056 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8057 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8058 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8059
8060 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8061 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8062 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8063 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8064 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8065 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008066 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8067 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8068 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8069 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8070 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8071 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008072
8073 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8074 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8075 the request.
8076
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008077 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8078 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8079 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8080
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008081 Example :
8082 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8083 # last 30 minutes
8084 backend pop
8085 mode tcp
8086 balance roundrobin
8087 stick store-request src
8088 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8089 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8090 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8091
8092 backend smtp
8093 mode tcp
8094 balance roundrobin
8095 stick match src table pop
8096 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8097 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8098
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008099 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008100 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008101
8102
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008103stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008104 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8105 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008106 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008108 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008109
8110 Arguments :
8111 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8112 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8113 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8114 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8115
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008116 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8117 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8118 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8119 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8120
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008121 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8122 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8123 instance.
8124
8125 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8126 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8127 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8128 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8129 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8130 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008131 to 32 characters.
8132
8133 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8134 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8135 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008136 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008137 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8138 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008139
8140 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008141 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8142 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008143 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8144 increase.
8145
8146 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008147 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8148 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8149 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008150
8151 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8152 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8153 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8154 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8155 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8156 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8157 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8158 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8159 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8160 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8161 parameter (see below).
8162
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008163 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8164 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8165 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8166 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8167 soft restart.
8168
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008169 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8170 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008171
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008172 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8173 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8174 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8175 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8176 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008177 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008178 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8179 if not expiration delay is specified.
8180
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008181 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8182 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8183 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8184 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008185 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8186 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8187 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8188 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8189 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8190 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8191 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8192 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8193 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8194 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8195 types and their arguments.
8196
8197 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8198 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8199 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8200 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8201
8202 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8203 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8204 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8205 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8206
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008207 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8208 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8209 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8210 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8211 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8212 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8213
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008214 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8215 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8216 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8217 they were received.
8218
8219 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8220 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8221 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8222 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8223 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8224
8225 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8226 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8227 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8228 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8229 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8230
8231 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8232 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8233 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8234
8235 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8236 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8237 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8238 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8239 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8240
8241 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8242 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8243 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8244 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8245 the client side.
8246
8247 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8248 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8249 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8250 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8251 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8252 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8253 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8254
8255 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8256 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8257 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8258 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8259 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8260 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8261 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8262
8263 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8264 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8265 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8266 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8267 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8268 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8269
8270 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8271 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8272 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8273 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8274
8275 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8276 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8277 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8278 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8279 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8280 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8281 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8282 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8283 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8284 recommended for better fairness.
8285
8286 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8287 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8288 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8289 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8290
8291 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8292 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8293 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8294 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8295 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8296 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8297 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8298 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8299 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8300 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008301
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008302 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8303 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008304 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8305 reference it.
8306
8307 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8308 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008309 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8310 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8311 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008312
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008313 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8314 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8315 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8316 something that can be ignored.
8317
8318 Example:
8319 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8320 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8321 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8322 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8323
8324 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008325 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008326
8327
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008328stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008329 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8331 no | no | yes | yes
8332
8333 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008334 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008335 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8336 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8337 server is selected.
8338
8339 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8340 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8341 the "stick-table" statement.
8342
8343 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8344 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8345 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8346 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8347
8348 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8349 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8350 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8351 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8352 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8353 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008354 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008355 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8356 rules.
8357
8358 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8359 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8360 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8361 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8362 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8363 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8364 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8365
8366 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8367 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8368 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8369 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8370
8371 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8372 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8373 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8374 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8375 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8376 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008377 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8378 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8379 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8380 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8381 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8382 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8383 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8384 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8385 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008386
8387 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8388
8389 Example :
8390 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8391 backend https
8392 mode tcp
8393 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008394 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008395 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008396
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008397 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8398 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8399
8400 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8401 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8402 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8403
8404 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8405 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008406
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008407 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8408 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8409 # at offset 44.
8410
8411 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8412 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8413
8414 # Learn on response if server hello.
8415 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008416
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008417 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8418 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8419
8420 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8421 extraction.
8422
8423
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008424tcp-check connect [params*]
8425 Opens a new connection
8426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8427 no | no | yes | yes
8428
8429 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8430 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8431 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8432
8433 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8434 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8435 of the sequence.
8436
8437 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8438 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8439 do.
8440
8441 Parameters :
8442 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8443 use the TCP connection.
8444
8445 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8446 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8447 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8448
8449 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8450
8451 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8452
8453 Examples:
8454 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8455 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8456 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8457 option tcp-check
8458 tcp-check connect
8459 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8460 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8461 tcp-check send \r\n
8462 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8463 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8464 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8465 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8466 tcp-check send \r\n
8467 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8468 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8469
8470 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8471 option tcp-check
8472 tcp-check connect port 110
8473 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8474 tcp-check connect port 143
8475 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8476 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8477
8478 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8479
8480
8481tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8482 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8483 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8484 no | no | yes | yes
8485
8486 Arguments :
8487 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8488 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8489 binary.
8490 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8491 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8492 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8493
8494 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8495 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8496 with the usual backslash ('\').
8497 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8498 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8499 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8500 used upper or lower case.
8501
8502
8503 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8504
8505 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8506 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8507 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8508 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8509 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8510 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8511 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8512 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8513
8514 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8515 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8516 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8517 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8518 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8519 expression.
8520
8521 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8522 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8523 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8524 this exact hexadecimal string.
8525 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8526
8527 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8528 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8529 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8530 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8531 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8532 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8533 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8534 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8535 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8536 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8537 the null character.
8538
8539 Examples :
8540 # perform a POP check
8541 option tcp-check
8542 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8543
8544 # perform an IMAP check
8545 option tcp-check
8546 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8547
8548 # look for the redis master server
8549 option tcp-check
8550 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008551 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008552 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8553 tcp-check expect string role:master
8554 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8555 tcp-check expect string +OK
8556
8557
8558 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8559 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8560
8561
8562tcp-check send <data>
8563 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8564 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8565 no | no | yes | yes
8566
8567 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8568 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8569
8570 Examples :
8571 # look for the redis master server
8572 option tcp-check
8573 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8574 tcp-check expect string role:master
8575
8576 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8577 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8578
8579
8580tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8581 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8582 tcp health check
8583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8584 no | no | yes | yes
8585
8586 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8587 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8588 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8589 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8590 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8591 hexadecimal string.
8592 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8593
8594 Examples :
8595 # redis check in binary
8596 option tcp-check
8597 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8598 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8599
8600
8601 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8602 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8603
8604
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008605tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8606 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8608 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008609 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008610 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8611 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008612
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008613 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008614
8615 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8616 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008617 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8618 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8619 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8620 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8621 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8622 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008623
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008624 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8625 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8626 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8627 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008628
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008629 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008630 - accept :
8631 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8632 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8633 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008634
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008635 - reject :
8636 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8637 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8638 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8639 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8640 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8641 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8642 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8643 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8644 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8645 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8646 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8647 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008648
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008649 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8650 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8651 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8652 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8653 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8654 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8655 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8656 hosts.
8657
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008658 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8659 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8660 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8661 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8662 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8663 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8664 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8665 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8666
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008667 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8668 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8669 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8670 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8671 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8672 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8673 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8674 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8675 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008676 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8677 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008678
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008679 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008680 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008681 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008682 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008683 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8684 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008685 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008686 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8687 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8688 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8689 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8690 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008691
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008692 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008693 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008694 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008695 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8696 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8697 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8698 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008699
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008700 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8701 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8702 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8703 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008704
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008705 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8706 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8707 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8708 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8709 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008710 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8711 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8712 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8713 layer7 information is extracted.
8714
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008715 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8716 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8717 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8718 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8719 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008720
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008721 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8722 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8723 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8724 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8725
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008726 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8727 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8728 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8729 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8730 continues.
8731
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008732 - set-src <expr> :
8733 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8734 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8735 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8736 set-src"
8737
8738 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8739 followed by some converters.
8740
8741 Example:
8742
8743 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8744
8745 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
8746
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008747 - set-src-port <expr> :
8748 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8749 expression.
8750
8751 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8752 followed by some converters.
8753
8754 Example:
8755
8756 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8757
8758 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
8759 the source port to 0.
8760
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008761 - set-dst <expr> :
8762 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8763 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8764 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8765 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8766 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8767
8768 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8769 followed by some converters.
8770
8771 Example:
8772
8773 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8774 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8775
8776 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8777 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8778 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8779 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8780
8781
8782 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8783 followed by some converters.
8784
8785 Example:
8786
8787 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8788
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008789 - "silent-drop" :
8790 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8791 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8792 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8793 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8794 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8795 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8796 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8797 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8798 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8799 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8800 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8801 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8802 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8803 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8804 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8805 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8806
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008807 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8808 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8809 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008811 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8812 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8813 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008814
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008815 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008816 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008817 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008818
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008819 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8820 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8821 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008822
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008823 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008824 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8825 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008826
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008827 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8828
8829 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8830
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008831 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8832
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008833 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008834
8835
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008836tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8837 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008839 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008840 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008841 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8842 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008843
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008844 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008845
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008846 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8847 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8848 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8849 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8850 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008851
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008852 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8853 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8854 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8855 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008856 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8857 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8858 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8859 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8860 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8861 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008862 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008863 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008864
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008865 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8866 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8867 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8868 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008869
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008870 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008871 - accept : the request is accepted
8872 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8873 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008874 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008875 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02008876 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008877 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008878 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008879
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008880 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8881 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008882
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008883 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8884 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8885 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8886 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8887 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8888 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008890 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008891 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8892 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008893
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008894 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008895 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8896 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8897 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8898 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008899 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8900 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8901 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008902
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008903 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008904 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8905 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8906 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008907
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008908 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8909 declared inline.
8910
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008911 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8912 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8913 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8914 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008915 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008916 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008917 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008918 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8919 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008920 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008921 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8922 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008923
8924 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8925 followed by some converters.
8926
8927 Example:
8928
8929 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8930
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008931 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008932 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8933 # and reject everything else.
8934 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8935 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008936 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008937 tcp-request content reject
8938
8939 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008940 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8941 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8942 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008943 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008944
8945 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8946 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8947 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008948 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008949 tcp-request content reject
8950
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008951 Example:
8952 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8953 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008954 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008955
8956 Example:
8957 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8958 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008959 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008960
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008961 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8962 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8963
8964 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008965 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008966 # protecting all our sites
8967 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008968 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8969 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008970 ...
8971 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8972
8973 backend http_dynamic
8974 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008975 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008976 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008977 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8978 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8979 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008980 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008982 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008983
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008984 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008985
8986
8987tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8988 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008990 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008991 Arguments :
8992 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8993 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8994 as explained at the top of this document.
8995
8996 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8997 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8998 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8999 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9000 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9001
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009002 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9003 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9004 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9005 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9006
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009007 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9008 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009009 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009010 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009011 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9012 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9013 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9014 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009015
9016 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9017 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9018 it pass through unaffected.
9019
9020 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9021 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9022 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009023 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009024 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9025 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009026 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9027 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9028 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009029
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009030 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009031 "timeout client".
9032
9033
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009034tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9035 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9037 no | no | yes | yes
9038 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009039 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9040 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009041
9042 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9043
9044 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9045 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9046 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009047 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9048 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009049
9050 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9051
9052 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9053 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9054 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9055 inserted.
9056
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009057 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009058 - accept :
9059 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9060 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9061 the rules evaluation.
9062
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009063 - close :
9064 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9065 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9066 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9067 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9068 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9069 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009070 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009071 protocols.
9072
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009073 - reject :
9074 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9075 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009076 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009077
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009078 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9079 Sets a variable.
9080
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009081 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9082 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9083 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9084 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9085
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009086 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9087 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9088 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9089 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9090 continues.
9091
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009092 - "silent-drop" :
9093 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9094 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9095 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9096 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9097 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9098 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9099 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9100 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9101 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9102 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9103 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9104 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9105 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9106 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9107 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9108 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9109
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009110 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9111 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9112 for changing the default action to a reject.
9113
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009114 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9115 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9116 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9117 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009118 period.
9119
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009120 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9121 declared inline.
9122
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009123 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9124 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9125 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9126 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009127 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009128 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009129 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009130 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9131 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009132 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009133 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9134 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009135
9136 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9137 followed by some converters.
9138
9139 Example:
9140
9141 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9142
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009143 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9144
9145 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9146
9147
9148tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9149 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9151 no | no | yes | yes
9152 Arguments :
9153 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9154 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9155 as explained at the top of this document.
9156
9157 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9158
9159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009160timeout check <timeout>
9161 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9162 established.
9163
9164 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9165 yes | no | yes | yes
9166 Arguments:
9167 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9168 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9169 as explained at the top of this document.
9170
9171 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9172 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9173 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9174 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009175 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9176 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9177 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009178
9179 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9180 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9181
9182 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9183 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009184 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009185
9186 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9187 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9188 forget about it.
9189
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009190 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9191 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009192
9193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009194timeout client <timeout>
9195timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9196 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9198 yes | yes | yes | no
9199 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009200 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009201 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9202 as explained at the top of this document.
9203
9204 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9205 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9206 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009207 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9208 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9209 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9210 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009211 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9212 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9213 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009214 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009215 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009216 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9217 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009218 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9219 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009220
9221 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9222 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9223 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9224 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9225 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9226 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9227
9228 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9229 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9230 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9231
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009232 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9233 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009234
9235
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009236timeout client-fin <timeout>
9237 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9239 yes | yes | yes | no
9240 Arguments :
9241 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9242 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9243 as explained at the top of this document.
9244
9245 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9246 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9247 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9248 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9249 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9250 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9251 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9252 down in one direction.
9253
9254 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9255 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9256 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9257
9258 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9259
9260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009261timeout connect <timeout>
9262timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9263 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9265 yes | no | yes | yes
9266 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009267 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009268 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9269 as explained at the top of this document.
9270
9271 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009272 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009273 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009274 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009275 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9276 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009277
9278 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9279 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9280 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9281 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9282 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9283 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9284
9285 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9286 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9287 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9288
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009289 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9290 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009291
9292
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009293timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9294 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9296 yes | yes | yes | yes
9297 Arguments :
9298 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9299 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9300 as explained at the top of this document.
9301
9302 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9303 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9304 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9305 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9306 once the request has started to present itself.
9307
9308 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9309 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9310 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9311 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9312 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9313
9314 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9315 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9316 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9317 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9318
9319 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9320 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9321 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9322 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9323 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009324 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009325
9326 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9327 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9328 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9329 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9330
9331 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9332
9333
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009334timeout http-request <timeout>
9335 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009337 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009338 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009339 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9341 as explained at the top of this document.
9342
9343 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9344 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9345 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9346 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9347 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9348 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9349 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009350 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9351 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9352 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9353 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9354 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009355 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9356 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009357
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009358 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9359 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9360 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9361 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9362 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009363 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009364
9365 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9366 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9367 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9368 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9369 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9370
9371 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009372 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9373 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9374 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009375
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009376 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009377 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009378
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009379
9380timeout queue <timeout>
9381 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9383 yes | no | yes | yes
9384 Arguments :
9385 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9386 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9387 as explained at the top of this document.
9388
9389 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9390 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9391 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9392 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9393 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9394
9395 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9396 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9397 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9398 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9399
9400 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9401
9402
9403timeout server <timeout>
9404timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9405 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9407 yes | no | yes | yes
9408 Arguments :
9409 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9410 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9411 as explained at the top of this document.
9412
9413 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9414 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9415 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9416 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9417 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9418 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9419 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9420
9421 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9422 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9423 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9424 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9425 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009426 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009427 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009428 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9429 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9430 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9431 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009432
9433 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9434 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9435 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9436 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9437 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9438 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9439
9440 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9441 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9442 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9443
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009444 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009445
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009446
9447timeout server-fin <timeout>
9448 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9450 yes | no | yes | yes
9451 Arguments :
9452 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9453 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9454 as explained at the top of this document.
9455
9456 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9457 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9458 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9459 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9460 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9461 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9462 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9463 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9464 situations, it should not be needed.
9465
9466 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9467 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9468 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9469
9470 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9471
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009472
9473timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009474 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9476 yes | yes | yes | yes
9477 Arguments :
9478 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9479 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9480 as explained at the top of this document.
9481
9482 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9483 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9484 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9485
9486 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9487 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9488 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9489 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009490 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009491
9492 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9493
9494
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009495timeout tunnel <timeout>
9496 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9498 yes | no | yes | yes
9499 Arguments :
9500 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9501 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9502 as explained at the top of this document.
9503
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009504 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009505 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9506 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9507 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9508 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9509 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9510 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9511 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9512 specified.
9513
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009514 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9515 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9516 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9517 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9518 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9519 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9520 state.
9521
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009522 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9523 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9524 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9525 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9526 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9527
9528 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9529 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9530 forget about it.
9531
9532 Example :
9533 defaults http
9534 option http-server-close
9535 timeout connect 5s
9536 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009537 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009538 timeout server 30s
9539 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9540
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009541 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009542
9543
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009544transparent (deprecated)
9545 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009547 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009548 Arguments : none
9549
9550 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9551 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9552 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9553 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9554 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9555 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9556 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9557 appropriate server.
9558
9559 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9560
9561 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9562 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9563
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009564 See also: "option transparent"
9565
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009566unique-id-format <string>
9567 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9569 yes | yes | yes | no
9570 Arguments :
9571 <string> is a log-format string.
9572
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009573 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9574 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9575 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9576 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009577
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009578 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9579 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9580 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9581 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9582 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9583 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9584 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9585 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009586
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009587 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9588 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009589
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009590 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009591
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009592 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009593
9594 will generate:
9595
9596 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9597
9598 See also: "unique-id-header"
9599
9600unique-id-header <name>
9601 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9603 yes | yes | yes | no
9604 Arguments :
9605 <name> is the name of the header.
9606
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009607 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9608 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009609
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009610 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009611
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009612 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009613 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9614
9615 will generate:
9616
9617 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9618
9619 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009620
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009621use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009622 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9624 no | yes | yes | no
9625 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009626 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9627 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009628
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009629 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9630 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009631
9632 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9633 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9634 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009635 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9636 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9637 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9638 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009639
9640 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9641 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9642 assign the backend.
9643
9644 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9645 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9646 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9647 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9648 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9649 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9650
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009651 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009652 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009653 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9654 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9655 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9656
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009657 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9658 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9659 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9660 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9661 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9662 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9663 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9664 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9665 cannot be forced from the request.
9666
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009667 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009668 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9669 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9670
9671 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9672 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009673
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009674
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009675use-server <server> if <condition>
9676use-server <server> unless <condition>
9677 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9679 no | no | yes | yes
9680 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009681 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009682
9683 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9684
9685 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9686 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9687 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9688
9689 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9690 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9691 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9692 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9693 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9694 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9695 matches will assign the server.
9696
9697 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9698 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9699 with the next rules until one matches.
9700
9701 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9702 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9703 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9704 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9705
9706 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9707 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9708 stripped.
9709
9710 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9711 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9712 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9713 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9714
9715 Example :
9716 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9717 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9718 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9719 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9720 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9721 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9722 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9723 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9724 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9725
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009726 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009727
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009728
97295. Bind and Server options
9730--------------------------
9731
9732The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9733depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9734settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9735written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9736described in this section.
9737
9738
97395.1. Bind options
9740-----------------
9741
9742The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9743as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9744no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9745parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9746while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9747provided immediately after the setting name.
9748
9749The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9750
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009751accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
9752 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
9753 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
9754 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
9755 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
9756 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
9757 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
9758 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
9759 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
9760 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009761 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
9762 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
9763 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009764
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009765accept-proxy
9766 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009767 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9768 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009769 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9770 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9771 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9772 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9773 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9774 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9775 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009776 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9777 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009778
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009779alpn <protocols>
9780 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9781 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9782 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9783 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9784 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9785 initial NPN extension.
9786
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009787backlog <backlog>
9788 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9789 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9790
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009791ecdhe <named curve>
9792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009793 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9794 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009795
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009796ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9798 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9799 client's certificate.
9800
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009801ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9803 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9804 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9805 error is ignored.
9806
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009807ca-sign-file <cafile>
9808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9809 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9810 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9811 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9812 'generate-certificates' for details.
9813
9814ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9816 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9817 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9818 'generate-certificates' for details.
9819
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009820ciphers <ciphers>
9821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9822 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009823 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009824 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9825 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9826
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009827crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9829 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9830 to verify client's certificate.
9831
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009832crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9834 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9835 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9836 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9837 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9838 file.
9839
9840 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9841 are loaded.
9842
9843 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009844 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009845 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9846 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9847 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9848 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9849 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9850 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9851 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009852
9853 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9854 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9855 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9856 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009857 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9858 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009859
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009860 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009861
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009862 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9863 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009864 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009865 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9866 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9867 clients).
9868
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009869 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9870 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9871 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9872 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9873 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9874 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9875 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9876 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9877 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9878 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9879 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9880 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9881 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9882
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009883 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9884 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9885 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9886 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9887 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9888
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009889 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
9890 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
9891 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
9892 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009893
9894 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
9895 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
9896 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
9897 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
9898 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
9899 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
9900 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
9901 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
9902 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
9903
9904 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
9905
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009906 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009907 a cert bundle.
9908
9909 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
9910 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
9911 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
9912 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
9913 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
9914 provide multi-cert support.
9915
9916 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
9917
9918 Filename | CN | SAN
9919 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9920 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009921 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009922 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
9923 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9924
9925 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
9926 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
9927 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
9928 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
9929 suites.
9930
9931 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
9932 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
9933
9934 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
9935 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
9936 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
9937
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009938crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9940 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009941 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009942 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009943
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009944crt-list <file>
9945 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009946 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9947 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009948
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009949 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009950
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009951 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9952 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9953 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9954 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9955 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9956 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9957 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9958 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009959
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009960 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +02009961 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
9962 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009963
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009964defer-accept
9965 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9966 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9967 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9968 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9969 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9970 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9971 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9972 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9973 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9974 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9975 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9976
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009977force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009978 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009979 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009980 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9981 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009982
9983force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009984 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009985 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9986 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009987
9988force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009989 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009990 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9991 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009992
9993force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009994 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009995 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9996 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009997
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009998generate-certificates
9999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10000 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10001 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10002 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10003 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10004 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10005 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10006 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10007 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10008 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10009 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10010
10011 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10012 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10013 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10014 certificate is used many times.
10015
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010016gid <gid>
10017 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10018 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10019 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10020 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10021 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10022
10023group <group>
10024 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10025 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10026 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10027 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10028 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10029
10030id <id>
10031 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10032 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10033 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10034 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10035
10036interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010037 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10038 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10039 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10040 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10041 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10042 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10043 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010044
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010045level <level>
10046 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10047 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10048 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10049 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10050 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10051 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10052 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10053 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10054 counters).
10055 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10056 all counters).
10057
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010058maxconn <maxconn>
10059 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10060 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10061 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10062 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10063 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10064 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10065 eat all memory.
10066
10067mode <mode>
10068 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10069 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10070 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10071 UNIX sockets.
10072
10073mss <maxseg>
10074 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10075 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10076 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10077 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10078 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10079 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10080 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10081 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10082 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10083 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10084 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10085
10086name <name>
10087 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10088 page.
10089
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010090namespace <name>
10091 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10092 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10093 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10094 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10095
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010096nice <nice>
10097 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10098 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10099 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10100 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10101 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10102 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10103 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10104 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10105 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10106 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10107 one for an RDP socket.
10108
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010109no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010111 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010112 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010113 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10114 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010115 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010116
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010117no-tls-tickets
10118 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10119 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10120 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010121 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10122 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010123
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010124no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010126 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010127 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010128 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10129 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10130 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010131
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010132no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010133 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010134 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010135 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010136 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10137 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10138 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010139
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010140no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010142 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010143 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010144 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10145 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10146 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010147
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010148npn <protocols>
10149 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10150 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10151 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10152 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010153 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10154 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010155
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010156process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10157 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10158 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10159 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10160 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10161 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10162 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10163 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010164 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10165 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10166 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10167 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10168 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10169 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10170 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010171
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010172ssl
10173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010174 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010175 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10176 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10177 to deciphered contents.
10178
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010179strict-sni
10180 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10181 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10182 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10183 See the "crt" option for more information.
10184
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010185tcp-ut <delay>
10186 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10187 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10188 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10189 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10190 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10191 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10192 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10193 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10194 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10195 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10196 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10197
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010198tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010199 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010200 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10201 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10202 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10203 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10204 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10205 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10206 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010207 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10208 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10209 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010210
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010211tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10212 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10213 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10214 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10215 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10216 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10217 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10218 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10219 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10220 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10221 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10222
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010223transparent
10224 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10225 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10226 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10227 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10228 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10229 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10230 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10231 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10232 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10233 so check for support with your vendor.
10234
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010235v4v6
10236 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10237 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10238 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10239 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010240 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010241
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010242v6only
10243 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10244 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10245 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010246 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10247 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010248
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010249uid <uid>
10250 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10251 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10252 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10253 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10254 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10255
10256user <user>
10257 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10258 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10259 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10260 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10261 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10262
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010263verify [none|optional|required]
10264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10265 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10266 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10267 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10268 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010269 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10270 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10271 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10272 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010273
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200102745.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010275------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010277The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10278which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10279arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10280settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10281after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10282Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10283address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010285 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010286 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010288The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010289
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010290addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010291 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010292 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10293 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10294 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10295 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10296 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010298 Supported in default-server: No
10299
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010300agent-check
10301 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010302 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10303 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10304 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10305 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010306
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010307 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010308 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010309 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10310 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10311 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010312
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010313 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10314 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10315 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10316 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10317 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10318
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010319 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10320 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010321
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010322 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10323 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10324 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010325
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010326 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10327 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10328 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010329
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010330 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10331 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10332 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10333 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10334 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10335 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10336 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010337
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010338 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10339 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010340
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010341 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10342 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10343 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10344 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10345 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10346 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10347 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10348 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10349 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010350
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010351 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10352 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010353 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10354 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10355 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010356 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010357
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010358 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10359 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010360
10361 Supported in default-server: No
10362
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010363agent-send <string>
10364 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10365 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10366 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10367 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10368 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10369
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010370agent-inter <delay>
10371 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10372 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10373
10374 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10375 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10376 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10377 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10378 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10379 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10380 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10381 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10382 of backends use the same servers.
10383
10384 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10385
10386 Supported in default-server: Yes
10387
10388agent-port <port>
10389 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10390
10391 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10392
10393 Supported in default-server: Yes
10394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010395backup
10396 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10397 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10398 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10399 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10400 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10401 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010403 Supported in default-server: No
10404
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010405ca-file <cafile>
10406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10407 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10408 server's certificate.
10409
10410 Supported in default-server: No
10411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010412check
10413 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010414 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10415 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10416 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10417 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10418 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10419 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10420 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010421 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10422 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10423 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010425 Supported in default-server: No
10426
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010427check-send-proxy
10428 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10429 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10430 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10431 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10432 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10433 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10434 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10435
10436 Supported in default-server: No
10437
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010438check-ssl
10439 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10440 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10441 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10442 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010443 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010444 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10445 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10446 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10447 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10448
10449 Supported in default-server: No
10450
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010451ciphers <ciphers>
10452 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010453 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010454 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10455 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10456 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10457 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10458 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10459 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10460
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010461 Supported in default-server: No
10462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010463cookie <value>
10464 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10465 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10466 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10467 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10468 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10469 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10470 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010472 Supported in default-server: No
10473
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010474crl-file <crlfile>
10475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10476 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10477 to verify server's certificate.
10478
10479 Supported in default-server: No
10480
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010481crt <cert>
10482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10483 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10484 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10485 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10486 certificate request.
10487
10488 Supported in default-server: No
10489
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010490disabled
10491 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10492 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10493 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10494 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10495 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10496
10497 Supported in default-server: No
10498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010499error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010500 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10501 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10502 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010504 Supported in default-server: Yes
10505
10506 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010508fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010509 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10510 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10511 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010513 Supported in default-server: Yes
10514
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010515force-sslv3
10516 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10517 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010518 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10519 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010520
10521 Supported in default-server: No
10522
10523force-tlsv10
10524 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010525 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10526 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010527
10528 Supported in default-server: No
10529
10530force-tlsv11
10531 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010532 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10533 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010534
10535 Supported in default-server: No
10536
10537force-tlsv12
10538 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010539 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10540 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010541
10542 Supported in default-server: No
10543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010544id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010545 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10546 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10547 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010549 Supported in default-server: No
10550
10551inter <delay>
10552fastinter <delay>
10553downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010554 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10555 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10556 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10557 between checks depending on the server state :
10558
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010559 Server state | Interval used
10560 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10561 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10562 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10563 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10564 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10565 or yet unchecked. |
10566 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10567 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10568 | "inter" otherwise.
10569 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010571 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10572 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10573 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10574 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010575 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10576 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10577 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10578 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10579 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010581 Supported in default-server: Yes
10582
10583maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010584 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10585 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10586 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10587 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10588 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10589 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10590 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10591 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010593 Supported in default-server: Yes
10594
10595maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010596 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10597 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10598 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10599 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10600 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10601 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10602 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010604 Supported in default-server: Yes
10605
10606minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010607 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10608 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10609 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10610 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10611 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10612 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010613 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010614 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010616 Supported in default-server: Yes
10617
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010618namespace <name>
10619 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10620 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10621 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10622 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10623
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010624no-ssl-reuse
10625 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10626 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10627 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10628 and for paranoid users.
10629
10630 Supported in default-server: No
10631
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010632no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010633 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10634 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010635 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010636
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010637 Supported in default-server: No
10638
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010639no-tls-tickets
10640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10641 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10642 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010643 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10644 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010645
10646 Supported in default-server: No
10647
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010648no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010649 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010650 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10651 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010652 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10653 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10654 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010655
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010656 Supported in default-server: No
10657
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010658no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010659 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010660 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10661 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010662 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10663 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10664 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010665
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010666 Supported in default-server: No
10667
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010668no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010669 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010670 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10671 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010672 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10673 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10674 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010675
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010676 Supported in default-server: No
10677
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010678non-stick
10679 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10680 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10681 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10682
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010683 Supported in default-server: No
10684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010685observe <mode>
10686 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10687 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10688 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10689 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10690 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10691 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010692 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010694 Supported in default-server: No
10695
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010696 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010698on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010699 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10700 Currently, four modes are available:
10701 - fastinter: force fastinter
10702 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10703 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10704 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10705 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010707 Supported in default-server: Yes
10708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010709 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10710
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010711on-marked-down <action>
10712 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10713 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010714 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10715 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10716 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10717 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10718 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10719 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10720 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10721 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010722
10723 Actions are disabled by default
10724
10725 Supported in default-server: Yes
10726
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010727on-marked-up <action>
10728 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10729 Currently one action is available:
10730 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10731 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10732 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10733 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10734 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10735 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10736 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10737 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10738
10739 Actions are disabled by default
10740
10741 Supported in default-server: Yes
10742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010743port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010744 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10745 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10746 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10747 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10748 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10749 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010751 Supported in default-server: Yes
10752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010753redir <prefix>
10754 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10755 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10756 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10757 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10758 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10759 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10760 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10761 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010762 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010763 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10764 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10765 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10766 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10767 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10768
10769 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010771 Supported in default-server: No
10772
10773rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010774 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10775 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10776 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010778 Supported in default-server: Yes
10779
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010780resolve-prefer <family>
10781 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10782 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10783 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10784 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10785
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010786 Default value: ipv6
10787
10788 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010789
10790 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10791
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010792resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10793 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10794 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10795 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10796 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10797 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10798 configured network, another address is selected.
10799
10800 Supported in default-server: Yes
10801
10802 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
10803
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010804resolvers <id>
10805 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10806 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010807 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10808 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10809 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10810 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010811
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010812 Supported in default-server: No
10813
10814 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010815
10816 See also chapter 5.3
10817
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010818send-proxy
10819 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10820 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10821 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10822 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010823 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
10824 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
10825 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
10826 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
10827 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
10828 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
10829 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
10830 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
10831 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
10832 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
10833 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
10834 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010835
10836 Supported in default-server: No
10837
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010838send-proxy-v2
10839 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10840 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10841 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10842 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10843 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10844 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10845 option of the "bind" keyword.
10846
10847 Supported in default-server: No
10848
10849send-proxy-v2-ssl
10850 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10851 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10852 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10853 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10854 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10855 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10856 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10857 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10858
10859 Supported in default-server: No
10860
10861send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10862 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10863 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10864 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10865 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10866 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10867 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10868 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10869 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10870 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10871
10872 Supported in default-server: No
10873
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010874slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010875 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10876 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10877 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10878 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10879 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10880 parameters :
10881
10882 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10883 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10884
10885 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10886 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10887 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10888 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10889
10890 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10891 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10892 seen as failed.
10893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010894 Supported in default-server: Yes
10895
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010896sni <expression>
10897 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10898 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10899 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10900 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10901 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10902
10903 Supported in default-server: no
10904
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010905source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010906source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010907source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010908 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10909 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10910 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10911 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10912
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010913 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10914 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10915 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10916 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10917 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10918 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10919 server.
10920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010921 Supported in default-server: No
10922
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010923ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010924 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10925 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10926 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10927 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10928 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10929 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010930 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010931
10932 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010933
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010934tcp-ut <delay>
10935 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10936 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10937 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10938 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10939 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10940 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10941 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10942 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10943 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10944 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10945 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10946 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10947 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010949track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010950 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10951 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10952 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10953 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010954 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010956 Supported in default-server: No
10957
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010958verify [none|required]
10959 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010960 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10961 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10962 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10963 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010964 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10965 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10966 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010967
10968 Supported in default-server: No
10969
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010970verifyhost <hostname>
10971 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10972 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10973 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10974 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10975 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10976 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10977
10978 Supported in default-server: No
10979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010980weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010981 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10982 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10983 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010984 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10985 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10986 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10987 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10988 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10989 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010991 Supported in default-server: Yes
10992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010993
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200109945.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10995-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010996
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010997HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
10998using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10999configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011000This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11001can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11002workload.
11003This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11004resolution at run time.
11005Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11006carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11007
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011008Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11009health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11010
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011011
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110125.3.1. Global overview
11013----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011014
11015As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11016different steps of the process life:
11017
11018 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11019 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11020 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11021
11022 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11023 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11024 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11025
11026A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11027 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11028 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11029 resolution to know this new IP.
11030
11031A few things important to notice:
11032 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11033 first valid response.
11034
11035 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11036 servers return an error.
11037
11038
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110395.3.2. The resolvers section
11040----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011041
11042This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11043HAProxy.
11044There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11045many name servers.
11046
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011047When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11048uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11049is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11050answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11051
11052When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11053used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11054
11055Two types of behavior can be applied:
11056 1. stop DNS resolution
11057 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11058 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11059 1. ANY query type
11060 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11061 server's parameter
11062 3. remaining family type
11063
11064HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11065 - invalid DNS response packet
11066 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11067 - NX domain
11068 - Query refused by server
11069 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11070
11071HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11072 - no Answer records in the response
11073 - DNS response truncated
11074 - Error in DNS response
11075 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11076 - name server timeout
11077
11078For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11079 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11080 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11081 applied;
11082 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11083 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11084 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11085 stops resolution.
11086
11087
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011088resolvers <resolvers id>
11089 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11090
11091A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11092
11093nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11094 DNS server description:
11095 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11096 <ip> : IP address of the server
11097 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11098
11099hold <status> <period>
11100 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11101 on last resolution <status>
11102 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
11103 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11104 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11105 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11106
11107 Default value is 10s for "valid".
11108
11109 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11110 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11111 the healch check.
11112
11113resolve_retries <nb>
11114 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11115 giving up.
11116 Default value: 3
11117
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011118 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11119 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11120 type.
11121
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011122timeout <event> <time>
11123 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11124 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11125 events available are:
11126 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11127 been received.
11128 Default value: 1s
11129 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11130 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11131
11132Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
11133
11134 resolvers mydns
11135 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11136 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11137 resolve_retries 3
11138 timeout retry 1s
11139 hold valid 10s
11140
11141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111426. HTTP header manipulation
11143---------------------------
11144
11145In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11146response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11147request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11148which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011149against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011150
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011151If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11152to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11153but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11154HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11155stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11156because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11157a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11158still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011160This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11161in section 4.2 :
11162
11163 - reqadd <string>
11164 - reqallow <search>
11165 - reqiallow <search>
11166 - reqdel <search>
11167 - reqidel <search>
11168 - reqdeny <search>
11169 - reqideny <search>
11170 - reqpass <search>
11171 - reqipass <search>
11172 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11173 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11174 - reqtarpit <search>
11175 - reqitarpit <search>
11176 - rspadd <string>
11177 - rspdel <search>
11178 - rspidel <search>
11179 - rspdeny <search>
11180 - rspideny <search>
11181 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11182 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11183
11184With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11185is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11186parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11187prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11188Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11189
11190 \t for a tab
11191 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11192 \n for a new line (LF)
11193 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11194 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11195 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11196 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11197 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11198
11199The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11200portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11201above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11202regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
112039 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11204is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11205
11206The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11207after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11208
11209Notes related to these keywords :
11210---------------------------------
11211 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11212 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11213 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11214
11215 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11216 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11217 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11218
11219 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11220 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11221 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11222 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11223 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11224
11225 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11226 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11227 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11228 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11229 useless headers before adding new ones.
11230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011231 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011232 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11233
11234 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11235 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11236 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11237
11238 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11239 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011240 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011241
11242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112437. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11244----------------------------------
11245
11246Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11247client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11248The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11249these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11250but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11251data called patterns.
11252
11253
112547.1. ACL basics
11255---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011256
11257The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11258content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11259from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11260simple :
11261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011262 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011263 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011264 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11265 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011267The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11268adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011269
11270In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011272 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011273
11274This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11275Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11276and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011277an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11278conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11279as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11280are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011281
11282ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11283'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11284which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11285
11286There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11287performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011289The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11290specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11291this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011292methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11293ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294
11295Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11296 - boolean
11297 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11298 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11299 - string
11300 - data block
11301
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011302Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11303converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11304would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11305The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11306which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11307
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011308Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11309keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11310fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11311which are summarized in the table below :
11312
11313 +---------------------+-----------------+
11314 | Sample or converter | Default |
11315 | output type | matching method |
11316 +---------------------+-----------------+
11317 | boolean | bool |
11318 +---------------------+-----------------+
11319 | integer | int |
11320 +---------------------+-----------------+
11321 | ip | ip |
11322 +---------------------+-----------------+
11323 | string | str |
11324 +---------------------+-----------------+
11325 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11326 +---------------------+-----------------+
11327
11328Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11329matching method, see below.
11330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011331The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11332 - boolean
11333 - integer or integer range
11334 - IP address / network
11335 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11336 - regular expression
11337 - hex block
11338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011339The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11340
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011341 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11342 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011343 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011344 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011345 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011346 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011347 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011349The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11350read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11351if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11352lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11353will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11354beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11355a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11356lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11357exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11358
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011359The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11360parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11361ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11362a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11363check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11364
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011365The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11366socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11367file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011369Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11370loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11371
11372 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11373
11374In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11375the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11376case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11377as well.
11378
11379The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11380sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11381do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11382methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11383is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11384obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11385followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11386default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11387that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11388string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11389
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011390The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11391By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11392string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11393resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11394server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11395waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11396flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11397function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011399There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11400sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11401be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011402
11403 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11404 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011405 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11406 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11407 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11408 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011409
11410 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11411 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011412 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011413
11414 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011415 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011416
11417 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011418 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011419
11420 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11421 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11422
11423 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11424 binary or string samples.
11425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11427 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011429 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11430 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11431 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011433 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11434 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011436 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11437 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011439 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11440 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011442 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11443 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011444 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011446 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11447 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11448 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011449
11450For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11451request, it is possible to do :
11452
11453 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11454
11455In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11456buffer, one would use the following acl :
11457
11458 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11459
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011460On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11461possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11462
11463 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011465All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11466criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11467method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11468to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11469criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11470the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011472If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011473the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11474For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011476 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11477 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11478 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11479 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011480
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011481
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011482The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11483types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11484combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11485brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11486default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011488 +-------------------------------------------------+
11489 | Input sample type |
11490 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011491 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011492 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11493 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11494 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011495 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011496 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011497 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011498 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011499 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011500 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011501 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011502 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011503 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011504 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011505 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011506 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011507 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011508 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011509 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011510 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011511 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011512 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011513 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011514 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011515 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011516 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11517 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11518 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011519
11520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115217.1.1. Matching booleans
11522------------------------
11523
11524In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11525Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11526When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11527that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11528
11529Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11530return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11531"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11532
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115347.1.2. Matching integers
11535------------------------
11536
11537Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11538enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11539to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11540
11541Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11542matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11543lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011544
11545For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11546unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11547representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11548
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011549As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11550two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11551instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11552ranges and operators.
11553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011554For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011555operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11556Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11557of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011558
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011559Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011560
11561 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11562 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11563 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11564 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11565 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11566
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011567For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011568
11569 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11570
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011571This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11572
11573 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115767.1.3. Matching strings
11577-----------------------
11578
11579String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11580different forms :
11581
11582 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11583 patterns ;
11584
11585 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11586 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11587
11588 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11589 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11590
11591 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11592 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11593
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011594 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011595 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11596 matches.
11597
11598 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11599 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11600 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011601
11602String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11603exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11604characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11605string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11606to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011607before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011608
11609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116107.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11611---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011612
11613Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11614they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11615possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11616passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11617the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011618the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11619match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011620
11621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116227.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11623-------------------------------------
11624
11625It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11626not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11627a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11628to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11629digits may be used upper or lower case.
11630
11631Example :
11632 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11633 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11634
11635
116367.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11637---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011638
11639IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11640netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11641within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011642host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011643difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11644at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11645does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11646parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011647
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011648The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11649abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11650
11651 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11652 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11653 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11654 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11655 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11656 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11657 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11658 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11659
11660Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11661192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11662
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011663IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11664Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11665trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11666IPv6 patterns.
11667
11668HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11669following situations :
11670 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11671 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11672 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11673 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11674 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11675 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11676 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11677 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11678 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11679 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011681
116827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11683----------------------------------
11684
11685Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11686combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11687
11688 - AND (implicit)
11689 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11690 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011692A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011694 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011696Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11697indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011699For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11700"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11701requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11702is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11703
11704 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11705 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11706 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11707 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11708
11709To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11710and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11711
11712 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11713 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11714 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11715 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11716
11717 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11718 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11719 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11720 use_backend www if host_www
11721
11722It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11723expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11724be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11725the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11726
11727 The following rule :
11728
11729 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11730 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11731
11732 Can also be written that way :
11733
11734 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11735
11736It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11737to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11738simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11739sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11740good use is the following :
11741
11742 With named ACLs :
11743
11744 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11745 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11746 monitor fail if site_dead
11747
11748 With anonymous ACLs :
11749
11750 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11751
11752See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11753
11754
117557.3. Fetching samples
11756---------------------
11757
11758Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11759against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11760sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11761ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11762of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11763available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11764
11765This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11766Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11767compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11768deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11769
11770The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11771matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11772method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11773indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11774
11775As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11776when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11777mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11778the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11779ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11780
11781Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11782multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11783when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11784incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11785are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11786is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11787all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11788
11789Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11790 - name
11791 - name(arg1)
11792 - name(arg1,arg2)
11793
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011794
117957.3.1. Converters
11796-----------------
11797
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011798Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11799of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11800is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11801was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11802has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11803unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11804
11805These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11806sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11807the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11808support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011809
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011810A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11811support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11812supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11813(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11814bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011816The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011817
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011818add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011819 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011820 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011821 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
11822 scopes allowed are:
11823 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11824 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11825 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11826 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11827 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011828 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011829
11830and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011831 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011832 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011833 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11834 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11835 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11836 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11837 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11838 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11839 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011840 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011841
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011842base64
11843 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11844 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11845 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11846
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011847bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011848 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011849 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11850 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11851 presence of a flag).
11852
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011853bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11854 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11855 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11856 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11857
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011858cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011859 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11860 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011861
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011862crc32([<avalanche>])
11863 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11864 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11865 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11866 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11867 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11868 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11869 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11870 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11871 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11872 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11873 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11874
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011875da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011876 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11877 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11878 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11879 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011880 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011881 configuration language.
11882
11883 Example:
11884 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011885 bind *:8881
11886 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011887 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011888
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011889debug
11890 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11891 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11892 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11893
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011894div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011895 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11896 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011897 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011898 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11899 scope. The scopes allowed are:
11900 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11901 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11902 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11903 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11904 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011905 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011906
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011907djb2([<avalanche>])
11908 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11909 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11910 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11911 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11912 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11913 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11914 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011915 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11916 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011917
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011918even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011919 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011920 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11921
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011922field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11923 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11924 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11925 list of chars.
11926
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011927hex
11928 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11929 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11930 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11931 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011932
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011933http_date([<offset>])
11934 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11935 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11936 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11937 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11938 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11939 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011940
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011941in_table(<table>)
11942 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11943 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11944 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11945 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11946 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11947
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011948ipmask(<mask>)
11949 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11950 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11951 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11952 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11953
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011954json([<input-code>])
11955 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11956 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11957 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11958 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11959 of errors:
11960 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11961 bytes, ...)
11962 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11963 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11964
11965 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11966 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11967 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11968 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11969 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11970 are :
11971 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11972 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11973 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11974 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11975 error ;
11976 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11977 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11978
11979 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11980 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11981
11982 Example:
11983 capture request header user-agent len 150
11984 capture request header Host len 15
Mac Browninge83345d2016-03-14 14:46:01 -040011985 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json("utf8s")]"}
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011986
11987 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11988 GET / HTTP/1.0
11989 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11990
11991 Output log:
11992 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11993
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011994language(<value>[,<default>])
11995 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11996 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11997 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11998 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11999 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12000 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12001 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12002 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12003 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12004 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12005 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12006 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012007
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012008 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012009
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012010 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12011 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012012
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012013 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12014 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12015 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12016 use_backend spanish if es
12017 use_backend french if fr
12018 use_backend english if en
12019 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012020
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012021lower
12022 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12023 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12024 type. The result is of type string.
12025
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012026ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12027 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12028 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12029 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12030 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12031 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12032 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12033
12034 Example :
12035
12036 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12037 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12038 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12039
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012040map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12041map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12042map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12043 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12044 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12045 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12046 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12047 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12048 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12049 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12050 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012052 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12053 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12054 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012055
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012056 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
12057 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012058
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012059 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12060 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12061 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12062 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012063 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12064 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012065 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12066 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12067 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12068 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12069 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12070 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12071 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12072 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012073 | | map_reg | |
12074 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12075 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012076 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12077 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12078 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12079 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12080 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012081
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012082 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12083 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12084 the corresponding match text.
12085
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012086 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12087 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12088 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12089 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12090 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012091
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012092 Example :
12093
12094 # this is a comment and is ignored
12095 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12096 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12097 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12098 | | | `---------- value
12099 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12100 | `---------------------------- key
12101 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12102
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012103mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012104 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12105 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012106 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012107 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12108 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12109 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12110 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12111 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12112 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012113 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012114
12115mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012116 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012117 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12118 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012119 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012120 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12121 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12122 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12123 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12124 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12125 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012126 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012127
12128neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012129 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12130 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12131 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12132 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012133
12134not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012135 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012136 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12137 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12138 absence of a flag).
12139
12140odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012141 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012142 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12143
12144or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012145 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012146 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012147 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12148 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12149 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12150 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12151 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12152 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12153 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012154 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012155
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012156regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012157 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12158 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12159 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12160 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12161 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12162 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12163 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12164 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12165 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12166 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012167 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12168 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12169 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12170 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012171
12172 Example :
12173
12174 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12175 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12176 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12177 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12178
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012179capture-req(<id>)
12180 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12181 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12182
12183 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012184 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12185 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012186
12187capture-res(<id>)
12188 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12189 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12190
12191 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012192 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12193 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012194
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012195sdbm([<avalanche>])
12196 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12197 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12198 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12199 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12200 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12201 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12202 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012203 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12204 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012205
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012206set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012207 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12208 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12209 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12210 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12211 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012212 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012213 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12214 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012215 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12216 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12217
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012218sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012219 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12220 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012221 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012222 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12223 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12224 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12225 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012226 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012227 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12228 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012229 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12230 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012231
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012232table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12233 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12234 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12235 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12236 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12237 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12238 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12239
12240
12241table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12242 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12243 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12244 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12245 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12246 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12247 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12248
12249table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12250 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12251 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12252 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12253 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12254 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12255
12256table_conn_cur(<table>)
12257 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12258 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12259 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12260 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12261 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12262
12263table_conn_rate(<table>)
12264 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12265 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12266 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12267 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12268 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12269
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012270table_gpt0(<table>)
12271 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12272 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12273 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12274 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12275 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12276
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012277table_gpc0(<table>)
12278 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12279 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12280 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12281 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12282 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12283
12284table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12285 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12286 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12287 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12288 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12289 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12290 sample fetch keyword.
12291
12292table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12293 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12294 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12295 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12296 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12297 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12298
12299table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12300 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12301 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12302 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12303 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12304 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12305 keyword.
12306
12307table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12308 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12309 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12310 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12311 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12312 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12313
12314table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12315 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12316 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12317 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12318 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12319 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12320 keyword.
12321
12322table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12323 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12324 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12325 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12326 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12327 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12328 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12329 keyword.
12330
12331table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12332 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12333 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12334 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12335 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12336 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12337 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12338 keyword.
12339
12340table_server_id(<table>)
12341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12343 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12344 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12345 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12346 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12347
12348table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12349 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12350 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12351 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12352 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12353 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12354 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12355 keyword.
12356
12357table_sess_rate(<table>)
12358 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12359 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12360 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12361 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12362 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12363 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12364 keyword.
12365
12366table_trackers(<table>)
12367 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12368 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12369 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12370 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12371 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12372 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12373 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12374 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12375 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12376 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12377
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012378upper
12379 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12380 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12381 type. The result is of type string.
12382
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012383url_dec
12384 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12385 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12386
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012387utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12388 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12389 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12390 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12391 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12392 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12393 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12394
12395 Example :
12396
12397 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12398 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12399 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12400
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012401word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12402 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12403 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12404
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012405wt6([<avalanche>])
12406 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12407 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12408 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12409 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12410 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12411 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12412 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012413 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12414 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012415
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012416xor(<value>)
12417 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012418 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012419 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012420 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12421 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12422 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012423 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012424 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12425 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012426 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12427 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012428
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012429
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124307.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012431--------------------------------------------
12432
12433A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12434not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12435"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12436The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12437
12438always_false : boolean
12439 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12440 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12441
12442always_true : boolean
12443 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12444 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12445
12446avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012447 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012448 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12449 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12450 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12451 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12452 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12453 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12454 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12455 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12456 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12457 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12458 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12459 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12460 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012462be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012463 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12464 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12465 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12466 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12467 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012469be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12470 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12471 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12472 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12473 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12474 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12475 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012476
12477 Example :
12478 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12479 backend dynamic
12480 mode http
12481 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12482 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012483
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012484bin(<hexa>) : bin
12485 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12486 of the string.
12487
12488bool(<bool>) : bool
12489 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12490 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012492connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12493 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012494 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012495 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12496 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012497
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012498 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012499 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012500 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12501
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012502 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12503 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012504
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012505 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012506 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012507 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012508 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12509 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012510 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012511 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012512
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012513 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12514 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012515 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012516 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012517
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012518date([<offset>]) : integer
12519 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12520 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12521 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12522 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012523 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12524
12525 Example :
12526
12527 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12528 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012529
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012530env(<name>) : string
12531 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12532 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12533 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12534 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12535 certain way.
12536
12537 Examples :
12538 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12539 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12540
12541 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12542 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012544fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12545 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012546 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12547 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12549 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12550 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12551 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12552 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012554fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12555 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12556 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12557 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12558 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12559 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12560 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12561 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12562 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012563
12564 Example :
12565 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12566 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12567 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12568 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12569 frontend mail
12570 bind :25
12571 mode tcp
12572 maxconn 100
12573 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12574 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12575 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12576 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012577
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012578int(<integer>) : signed integer
12579 Returns a signed integer.
12580
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012581ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12582 Returns an ipv4.
12583
12584ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12585 Returns an ipv6.
12586
12587meth(<method>) : method
12588 Returns a method.
12589
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012590nbproc : integer
12591 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12592 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12593 and debugging purposes.
12594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012595nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12596 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12597 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12598 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012599 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12600 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12601 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012602
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012603proc : integer
12604 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12605 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12606 debugging purposes.
12607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012608queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012609 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12610 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12611 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012612 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12613 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12614 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12615 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12616 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12617
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012618rand([<range>]) : integer
12619 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12620 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12621 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12622 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12623 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012625srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12626 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12627 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12628 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12629 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12630 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12631 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12632 methods.
12633
12634srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12635 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12636 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12637 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12638 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12639 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12640 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12641 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12642
12643srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12644 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12645 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012646 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012647 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12648 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12649 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12650 overloading servers).
12651
12652 Example :
12653 # Redirect to a separate back
12654 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12655 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12656 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12657
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012658stopping : boolean
12659 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12660 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12661 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12662
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012663str(<string>) : string
12664 Returns a string.
12665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12667 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12668 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12669
12670table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12671 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12672 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12673 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12674
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012675var(<var-name>) : undefined
12676 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012677 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12678 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12679 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12680 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012681 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012682 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12683 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012684 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12685 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12686
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200126877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012688----------------------------------
12689
12690The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12691closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12692methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12693sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12694TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012695the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12696counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12697"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012698argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12699the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12700this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701
12702be_id : integer
12703 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12704 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12705
12706dst : ip
12707 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12708 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12709 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12710 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12711 RFC 4291.
12712
12713dst_conn : integer
12714 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12715 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12716 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12717 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12718 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12719 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12720 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12721 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012723dst_port : integer
12724 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12725 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12726 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12727 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12728 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12729 an HTTP header.
12730
12731fe_id : integer
12732 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12733 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12734 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12735
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012736sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012737sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12738sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12739sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012740 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12741 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12742 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12743
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012744sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012745sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12746sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12747sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012748 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12749 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12750 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12751
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012752sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012753sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12754sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12755sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012756 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12757 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012758 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12759 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12760 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012761
12762 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12763 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012764 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12765 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12766 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012767 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12768 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12769
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012770sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012771sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12772sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12773sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012774 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12775 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012777sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012778sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12779sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12780sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012781 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12782 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12783 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12784
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012785sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012786sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12787sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12788sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012789 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12790 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12791 See also src_conn_rate.
12792
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012793sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012794sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12795sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12796sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012797 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012798 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012799
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012800sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12801sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12802sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12803sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12804 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12805 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12806
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012807sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012808sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12809sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12810sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012811 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12812 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12813 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012814 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12815 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12816 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012817
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012818sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012819sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12820sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12821sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012822 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12823 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12824 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012826sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012827sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12828sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12829sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012830 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12831 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12832 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12833 src_http_err_rate.
12834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012835sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012836sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12837sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12838sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012839 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12840 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12841 src_http_req_cnt.
12842
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012843sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012844sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12845sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12846sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012847 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12848 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12849 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12850 src_http_req_rate.
12851
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012852sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012853sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12854sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12855sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012856 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012857 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12858 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12859 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12860 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012861
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012862 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12863 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012864 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12865
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012866sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012867sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12868sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12869sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012870 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12871 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12872 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012874sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012875sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12876sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12877sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012878 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12879 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12880 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012881
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012882sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012883sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12884sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12885sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012886 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12887 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12888 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12889 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012890 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012891 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12892
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012893sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012894sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12895sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12896sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012897 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12898 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12899 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12900 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12901 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012902 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012904sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012905sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12906sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12907sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012908 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12909 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12910 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12911
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012912sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012913sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12914sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12915sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012916 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12917 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012918 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012919 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12920 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012921 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12922 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12923 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012925so_id : integer
12926 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12927 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12928 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012930src : ip
12931 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12932 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12933 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12934 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012935 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
12936 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
12937 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
12938 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012939
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012940 Example:
12941 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12942 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012944src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12945 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12946 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12947 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012948 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012950src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12951 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12952 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012953 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012954 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012956src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12957 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12958 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12959 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12960 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12961 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12962 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012963
12964 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12965 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12966 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12967 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012968 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012969 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12970 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012973 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012974 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012975 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012976 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012978src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012979 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012980 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12981 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012982 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012984src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12985 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12986 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12987 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012988 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012990src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012991 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012992 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012993 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012994 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012995
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012996src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12997 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12998 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
12999 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13000 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013002src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013003 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013005 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13006 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013007 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13008 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13009 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013011src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13012 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13013 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013014 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013015 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013016 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013018src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13019 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13020 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13021 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13022 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013023 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013025src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13026 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13027 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13028 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013029 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013031src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13032 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13033 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13034 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013035 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013036 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013038src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13039 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13040 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13041 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013042 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013043 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13044 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013045
13046 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013047 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013048 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013050src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013051 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13052 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13053 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13054 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13055 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013057src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013058 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13059 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13060 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13061 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13062 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064src_port : integer
13065 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13066 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13067 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13068 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013070src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13071 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013072 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13073 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13074 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013075 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13078 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13079 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13080 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13081 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013082 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013084src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13085 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13086 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13087 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13088 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13089 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13090 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13091 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13092 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013093
13094 Example :
13095 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13096 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13097 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13098 listen ssh
13099 bind :22
13100 mode tcp
13101 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013102 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013103 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013104 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013106srv_id : integer
13107 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13108 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13109 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013110
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010013111
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200131127.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013113----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013115The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13116closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13117when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13118usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013119future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013120
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013121ssl_bc : boolean
13122 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13123 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13124 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13125
13126ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13127 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13128 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13129
13130ssl_bc_cipher : string
13131 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13132 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13133
13134ssl_bc_protocol : string
13135 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13136 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13137
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013138ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013139 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013140 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13141 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013142
13143ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13144 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13145 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13146 if session was reused or not.
13147
13148ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13149 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13150 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013152ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13153 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13154 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13155 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13156 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13157 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013159ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13160 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13161 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13162 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13163 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013164
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013165ssl_c_der : binary
13166 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13167 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13168 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013170ssl_c_err : integer
13171 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13172 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13173 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13174 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13175 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013177ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13178 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13179 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13180 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13181 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13182 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13183 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13184 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13185 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013187ssl_c_key_alg : string
13188 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13189 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13190 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013192ssl_c_notafter : string
13193 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13194 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13195 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013197ssl_c_notbefore : string
13198 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13199 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13200 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013202ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13203 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13204 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13205 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13206 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13207 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13208 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13209 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13210 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013212ssl_c_serial : binary
13213 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13214 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13215 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013217ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13218 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13219 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13220 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013221 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13222 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13223
13224 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013226ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13227 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13228 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13229 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013231ssl_c_used : boolean
13232 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13233 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013235ssl_c_verify : integer
13236 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13237 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13238 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13239 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013241ssl_c_version : integer
13242 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13243 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013244
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013245ssl_f_der : binary
13246 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13247 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13248 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013250ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13251 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13252 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13253 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13254 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013255 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013256 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13257 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13258 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013260ssl_f_key_alg : string
13261 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13262 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13263 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013265ssl_f_notafter : string
13266 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13267 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13268 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013270ssl_f_notbefore : string
13271 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13272 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13273 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013275ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13276 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13277 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13278 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13279 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13280 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13281 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13282 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13283 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013285ssl_f_serial : binary
13286 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13287 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13288 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013289
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013290ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13291 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13292 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13293 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013295ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13296 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13297 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13298 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013300ssl_f_version : integer
13301 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13302 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13303
13304ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013305 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13306 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13307 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013309 Example :
13310 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13311 listen http-https
13312 bind :80
13313 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13314 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13315
13316ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13317 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13318 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13319
13320ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013321 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013322 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13323 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13324 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13325 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13326 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13327 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13328 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13329 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013331ssl_fc_cipher : string
13332 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13333 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013335ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013336 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13337 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013338 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13339 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13340 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13341 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013343ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13344 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013345 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13346 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13347 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13348 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013349
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013350ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013351 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13352 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013354ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013355 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013356 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13357 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13358 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13359 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13360 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13361 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13362 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013364ssl_fc_protocol : string
13365 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13366 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013367
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013368ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013369 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013370 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13371 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013373ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13374 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13375 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13376 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13377 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013379ssl_fc_sni : string
13380 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13381 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13382 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13383 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13384 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13385
13386 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13387 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13388 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013389 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13390 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013392 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013393 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13394 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013396ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13397 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13398 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013399
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013400
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200134017.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013402------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013404Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13405sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13406only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13407For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13408be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13409can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13410sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13411for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13412content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013414payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13415 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13416 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13417 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013419payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13420 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13421 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13422 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013424req.len : integer
13425req_len : integer (deprecated)
13426 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13427 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13428 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13429 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13430 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13431 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13432 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13433 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13436 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013437 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13438 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13439 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13440 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013442 ACL alternatives :
13443 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13446 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13447 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13448 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13449 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013451 ACL alternatives :
13452 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013454 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456req.proto_http : boolean
13457req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13458 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13459 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13460 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13461 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13462 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13463 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13464 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013466 Example:
13467 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13468 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13469 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013470 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013472req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13473rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13474 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13475 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13476 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13477 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13478 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13479 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13480 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013482 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13483 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13484 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13485 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13486 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13487 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013489 ACL derivatives :
13490 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013492 Example :
13493 listen tse-farm
13494 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13495 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13496 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13497 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13498 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13499 persist rdp-cookie
13500 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13501 # This is only useful makes sense if
13502 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13503 stick-table type string size 204800
13504 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13505 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13506 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013508 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13509 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013511req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13512rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13513 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13514 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13515 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13516 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013518 ACL derivatives :
13519 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013520
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013521req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13522 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13523 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013524 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13525 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13526 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13527 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13528 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013530req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13531req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13532 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13533 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13534 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13535 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13536 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13537 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13538 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013540req.ssl_sni : string
13541req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13542 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13543 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13544 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13545 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13546 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13547 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13548 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13549 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13550 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13551 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13552 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13553 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013555 ACL derivatives :
13556 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013558 Examples :
13559 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13560 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13561 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13562 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13563 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013564
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013565req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13566 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13567 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13568 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13569 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13570 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13571 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13572 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13573 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13574 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013576req.ssl_ver : integer
13577req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13578 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13579 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13580 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13581 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13582 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13583 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13584 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13585 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13586 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013588 ACL derivatives :
13589 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013590
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013591res.len : integer
13592 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13593 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13594 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13595 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13596 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13597 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13598 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13599 content inspection.
13600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013601res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13602 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013603 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13604 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13605 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13606 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013608res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13609 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13610 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13611 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13612 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013614 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013615
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013616res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13617rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13618 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13619 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13620 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13621 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13622 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13623 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13624 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013626wait_end : boolean
13627 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13628 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13629 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13630 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13631 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13632 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13633 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13634 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013636 Examples :
13637 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13638 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13639 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013641 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13642 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13643 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13644 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13645 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13646 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13647 tcp-request content reject
13648
13649
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136507.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013651--------------------------------------
13652
13653It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13654This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13655data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13656its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13657HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13658content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13659to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13660more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13661response are indexed.
13662
13663base : string
13664 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13665 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13666 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13667 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13668 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13669 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13670 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13671 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13672
13673 ACL derivatives :
13674 base : exact string match
13675 base_beg : prefix match
13676 base_dir : subdir match
13677 base_dom : domain match
13678 base_end : suffix match
13679 base_len : length match
13680 base_reg : regex match
13681 base_sub : substring match
13682
13683base32 : integer
13684 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13685 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13686 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013687 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13688 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13689 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013690
13691base32+src : binary
13692 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13693 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13694 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13695 per-URL counters.
13696
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013697capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13698 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13699 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13700 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13701
13702capture.req.method : string
13703 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13704 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13705 because it's allocated.
13706
13707capture.req.uri : string
13708 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13709 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13710 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13711 allocated.
13712
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013713capture.req.ver : string
13714 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13715 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13716 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13717
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013718capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13719 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13720 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13721 The first entry is an index of 0.
13722 See also: "capture response header"
13723
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013724capture.res.ver : string
13725 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13726 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13727 persistent flag.
13728
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013729req.body : binary
13730 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13731 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13732 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13733 the first chunk is analyzed.
13734
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013735req.body_param([<name>) : string
13736 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13737 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13738 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13739 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13740 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13741 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13742 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13743 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13744 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13745 given.
13746
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013747req.body_len : integer
13748 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13749 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13750 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13751 "option http-buffer-request".
13752
13753req.body_size : integer
13754 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13755 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13756 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13757 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13758 "option http-buffer-request".
13759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013760req.cook([<name>]) : string
13761cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13762 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13763 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13764 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13765 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13766 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13767 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13768 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13769 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13770
13771 ACL derivatives :
13772 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13773 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13774 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13775 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13776 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13777 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13778 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13779 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013781req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13782cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13783 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13784 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013786req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13787cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13788 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13789 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13790 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13791 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013793cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13794 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13795 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13796 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13797 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013798 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013799 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13800 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13801 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13802 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013804hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13805 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13806 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13807 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13808 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013809 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013811req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13812 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13813 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13814 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13815 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13816 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13817 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13818 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13819 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013821req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13822 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13823 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13824 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13825 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013827req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13828 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13829 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13830 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13831 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13832 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13833 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13834 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13835 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13836 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13837 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13838 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013840 ACL derivatives :
13841 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13842 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13843 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13844 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13845 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13846 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13847 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13848 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13849
13850req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13851hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13852 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13853 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13854 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13855 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13856 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13857 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13858 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13859 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13860 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13861
13862req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13863hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13864 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13865 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13866 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13867 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13868 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13869 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13870 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13871 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13872
13873req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13874hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13875 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13876 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13877 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13878 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13879 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13880 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13881 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13882
13883http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13884 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13885 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13886 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13887 basic auth is supported.
13888
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013889http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13890 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13891 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13892 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13893 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013894 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13895 basic auth is supported.
13896
13897 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013898 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13899 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13900 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13901 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013902
13903http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013904 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13905 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013906 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13907 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013909method : integer + string
13910 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13911 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13912 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13913 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13914 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13915 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13916 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013918 ACL derivatives :
13919 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013921 Example :
13922 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13923 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13924 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013926path : string
13927 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13928 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13929 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13930 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13931 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13932 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13933 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013935 ACL derivatives :
13936 path : exact string match
13937 path_beg : prefix match
13938 path_dir : subdir match
13939 path_dom : domain match
13940 path_end : suffix match
13941 path_len : length match
13942 path_reg : regex match
13943 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013944
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013945query : string
13946 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13947 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13948 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13949 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13950 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13951 which stops before the question mark.
13952
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013953req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13954 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13955 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13956 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13957 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013959req.ver : string
13960req_ver : string (deprecated)
13961 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13962 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13963 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013965 ACL derivatives :
13966 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013968res.comp : boolean
13969 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13970 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13971 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013973res.comp_algo : string
13974 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13975 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13976 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013978res.cook([<name>]) : string
13979scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13980 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13981 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13982 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013984 ACL derivatives :
13985 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013987res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13988scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13989 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13990 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13991 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013993res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13994scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13995 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13996 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13997 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013999res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14000 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14001 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14002 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14003 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14004 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14005 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14006 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14007 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14008 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014010res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14011 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14012 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14013 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14014 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14015 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014017res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14018shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14019 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14020 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14021 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14022 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14023 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14024 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14025 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14026 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014028 ACL derivatives :
14029 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14030 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14031 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14032 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14033 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14034 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14035 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14036 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14037
14038res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14039shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14040 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14041 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14042 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14043 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14044 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014046res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14047shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14048 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14049 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14050 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14051 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14052 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14053 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014054
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014055res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14056 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14057 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14058 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14059 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014061res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14062shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14063 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14064 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14065 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14066 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14067 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14068 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070res.ver : string
14071resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14072 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14073 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014075 ACL derivatives :
14076 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014078set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14079 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14080 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014081 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014082 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014084 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14085 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014087status : integer
14088 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14089 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14090 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014091
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014092unique-id : string
14093 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14094 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14095 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14096 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14097 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14098 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014100url : string
14101 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14102 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14103 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14104 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14105 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14106 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14107 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109 ACL derivatives :
14110 url : exact string match
14111 url_beg : prefix match
14112 url_dir : subdir match
14113 url_dom : domain match
14114 url_end : suffix match
14115 url_len : length match
14116 url_reg : regex match
14117 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014119url_ip : ip
14120 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14121 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14122 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14123 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14124 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14125 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14126 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014128url_port : integer
14129 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14130 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14131 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14132 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014133
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014134urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14135url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014136 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14137 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014138 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14139 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14140 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14141 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014142 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14143 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014144 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14145 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014147 ACL derivatives :
14148 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14149 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14150 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14151 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14152 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14153 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14154 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14155 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014156
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014158 Example :
14159 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14160 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14161 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14162 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014163
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014164urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014165 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14166 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14167 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014168
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014169url32 : integer
14170 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14171 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14172 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14173 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14174 is an unsigned integer.
14175
14176url32+src : binary
14177 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14178 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14179 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14180
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200141827.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014183---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014185Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14186every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014187order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014189ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14190---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014191FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014192HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014193HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14194HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014195HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14196HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14197HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14198HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14199LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014200METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014201METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014202METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14203METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14204METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14205METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014206METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014207METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014208RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014209REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014210TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014211WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14212---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014213
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142158. Logging
14216----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014217
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014218One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14219provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14220very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14221provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14222state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014223to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014224headers.
14225
14226In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14227about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14228send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14229
14230 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14231 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14232 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14233 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14234 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014235 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14236 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014237
14238The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14239allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14240as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14241while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14242real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14243delay.
14244
14245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142468.1. Log levels
14247---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014248
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014249TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014250source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014251HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14252in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14253track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14254syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14255about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014256
14257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142588.2. Log formats
14259----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014260
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014261HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014262and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14263slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14264options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014265
14266 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14267 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14268 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14269 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14270 extents.
14271
14272 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14273 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14274 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14275 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14276 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14277
14278 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14279 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14280 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14281 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14282 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14283
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014284 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14285 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14286 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14287 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14288
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014289 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14290
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014291Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14292specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14293field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14294servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14295always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14296identifier.
14297
14298Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14299 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14300 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14301 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14302 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14303
14304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143058.2.1. Default log format
14306-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014307
14308This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14309as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14310format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14311
14312 Example :
14313 listen www
14314 mode http
14315 log global
14316 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14317
14318 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14319 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14320 (www/HTTP)
14321
14322 Field Format Extract from the example above
14323 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14324 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14325 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14326 4 'to' to
14327 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14328 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14329
14330Detailed fields description :
14331 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14332 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14333 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14334 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14335 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14336 and processed the connection.
14337 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14338
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014339In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14340"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14341connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14342
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014343It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14344will eventually disappear.
14345
14346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143478.2.2. TCP log format
14348---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014349
14350The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14351is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14352information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14353counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14354emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14355environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14356the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14357sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014358specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14359not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14360fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14361marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014362
14363 Example :
14364 frontend fnt
14365 mode tcp
14366 option tcplog
14367 log global
14368 default_backend bck
14369
14370 backend bck
14371 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14372
14373 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14374 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14375 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14376
14377 Field Format Extract from the example above
14378 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14379 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14380 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14381 4 frontend_name fnt
14382 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14383 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14384 7 bytes_read* 212
14385 8 termination_state --
14386 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14387 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14388
14389Detailed fields description :
14390 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014391 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14392 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14393 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014394 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14395 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14396 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014397
14398 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014399 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14400 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14401 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014402
14403 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14404 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14405 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14406 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14407
14408 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14409 and processed the connection.
14410
14411 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14412 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14413 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14414 applications.
14415
14416 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14417 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14418 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14419 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14420 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14421
14422 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14423 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14424 See "Timers" below for more details.
14425
14426 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14427 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14428 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14429 "Timers" below for more details.
14430
14431 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014432 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014433 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14434 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14435 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14436 details.
14437
14438 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14439 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14440 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14441 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14442 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14443
14444 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14445 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14446 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14447 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14448 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14449 for more details.
14450
14451 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014452 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014453 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14454 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14455 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014456 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014457
14458 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14459 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14460 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14461 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14462 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14463 caused by a denial of service attack.
14464
14465 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14466 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14467 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14468 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14469 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14470 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14471 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14472 denial of service attack.
14473
14474 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14475 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14476 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14477 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14478 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14479 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14480 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14481 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14482 be processed than on other servers.
14483
14484 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14485 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14486 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14487 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14488 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14489 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14490 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14491 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14492 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14493 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14494 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14495 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14496 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14497
14498 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14499 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14500 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14501 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14502 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14503 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14504 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14505 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14506
14507 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14508 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14509 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14510 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14511 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14512 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14513 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14514 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14515 occurs.
14516
14517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145188.2.3. HTTP log format
14519----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014520
14521The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14522is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14523the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14524are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14525emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14526generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14527"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14528which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014529frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14530is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014531
14532Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14533slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14534with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14535
14536 Example :
14537 frontend http-in
14538 mode http
14539 option httplog
14540 log global
14541 default_backend bck
14542
14543 backend static
14544 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14545
14546 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14547 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14548 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014549 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014550
14551 Field Format Extract from the example above
14552 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14553 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
14554 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
14555 4 frontend_name http-in
14556 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
14557 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
14558 7 status_code 200
14559 8 bytes_read* 2750
14560 9 captured_request_cookie -
14561 10 captured_response_cookie -
14562 11 termination_state ----
14563 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14564 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14565 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14566 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14567 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014568
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014569
14570Detailed fields description :
14571 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014572 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14573 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14574 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014575 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14576 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14577 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014578
14579 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014580 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14581 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14582 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014583
14584 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
14585 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
14586 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
14587 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
14588 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
14589
14590 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14591 and processed the connection.
14592
14593 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14594 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14595 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14596
14597 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14598 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14599 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14600 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14601 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14602 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14603
14604 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
14605 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
14606 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
14607 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
14608 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
14609 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
14610
14611 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14612 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14613 See "Timers" below for more details.
14614
14615 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14616 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14617 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14618 below for more details.
14619
14620 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14621 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14622 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14623 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14624 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14625 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14626 for more details.
14627
14628 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014629 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014630 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14631 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14632 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14633 details.
14634
14635 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14636 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14637 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14638
14639 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14640 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14641 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14642 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14643 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14644 overflowing.
14645
14646 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14647 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14648 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14649 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14650 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14651 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14652 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14653 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14654
14655 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14656 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14657 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14658 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14659 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14660 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14661 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14662 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14663
14664 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14665 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14666 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14667 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14668 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14669 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14670 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14671
14672 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014673 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014674 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14675 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14676 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014677 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014678 system.
14679
14680 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14681 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14682 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14683 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14684 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14685 caused by a denial of service attack.
14686
14687 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14688 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14689 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14690 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14691 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14692 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14693 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14694 denial of service attack.
14695
14696 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14697 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14698 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14699 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14700 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14701 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14702 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14703 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14704 processed than on other servers.
14705
14706 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14707 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14708 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14709 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14710 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14711 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14712 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14713 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14714 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14715 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14716 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14717 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14718 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14719
14720 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14721 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14722 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14723 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14724 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14725 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14726 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14727 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14728
14729 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14730 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14731 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14732 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14733 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14734 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14735 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14736 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14737 occurs.
14738
14739 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14740 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14741 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14742 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14743 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14744 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14745 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14746 cookies" below for more details.
14747
14748 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14749 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14750 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14751 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14752 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14753 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14754 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14755 and cookies" below for more details.
14756
14757 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14758 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14759 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14760 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14761 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14762 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14763 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14764 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14765
14766
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200147678.2.4. Custom log format
14768------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014769
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014770The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014771mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014772
14773HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14774Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14775separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14776prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14777
14778Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14779variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014780("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014781
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014782If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014783as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014784less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14785the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14786
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014787Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014788In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014789in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014790
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014791Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
14792'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
14793https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
14794such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
14795
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014796Flags are :
14797 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014798 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014799 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
14800 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014801
14802 Example:
14803
14804 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14805 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14806
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014807 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
14808
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014809At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14810
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014811 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14812 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014813
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014814the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014815
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014816 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014817 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014818 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014819
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014820and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14821
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014822 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014823 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14824
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014825Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14826
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014827 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014828 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014829 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14830 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14831 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014832 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14833 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14834 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014835 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014836 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14837 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014838 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014839 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14840 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014841 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014842 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014843 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014844 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020014845 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014846 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014847 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14848 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014849 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014850 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14851 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014852 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014853 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14854 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014855 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14856 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14857 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014858 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014859 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14860 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014861 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014862 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14863 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14864 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014865 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014866 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014867 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14868 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14869 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14870 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014871 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014872 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014873 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014874 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014875 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014876 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014877 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14878 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14879 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014880 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014881 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14882 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014883 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014884 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014885 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014886 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014887
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014888 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014889
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014890
148918.2.5. Error log format
14892-----------------------
14893
14894When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14895protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14896By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14897"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14898will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14899logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14900
14901The format looks like this :
14902
14903 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14904 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14905 Connection error during SSL handshake
14906
14907 Field Format Extract from the example above
14908 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14909 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14910 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14911 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14912 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14913
14914These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14915failures.
14916
14917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149188.3. Advanced logging options
14919-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014920
14921Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14922just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14923options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14924for more information about their usage.
14925
14926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149278.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14928------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014929
14930It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14931haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14932commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14933monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14934ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14935
14936 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14937 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14938 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14939 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14940
14941 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14942 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14943 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014944 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014945 such as other load-balancers.
14946
14947 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14948 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14949 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14950
14951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149528.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14953----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014954
14955The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14956what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14957or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14958"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14959just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14960log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14961after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14962is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14963with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14964with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14965
14966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149678.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14968------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014969
14970Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14971for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14972"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14973retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14974raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14975a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14976file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14977you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14978"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14979
14980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149818.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14982--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014983
14984Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14985multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14986them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14987"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14988logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14989error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14990and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14991too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14992useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14993alternative.
14994
14995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149968.4. Timing events
14997------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014998
14999Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15000reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15001the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15002frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
15003mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
15004
15005 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15006 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
15007 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
15008 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
15009 the client closes prematurely or times out.
15010
15011 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15012 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15013 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15014 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15015 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15016
15017 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15018 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15019 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15020 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15021 connection never established.
15022
15023 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15024 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15025 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15026 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15027 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15028 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15029 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15030 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15031 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15032 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15033 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15034
15035 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15036 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
15037 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
15038 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015039 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015040
15041 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15042
15043 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
15044 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
15045 negative.
15046
15047These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15048protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15049that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015050due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015051close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
15052session has been aborted on timeout.
15053
15054Most common cases :
15055
15056 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15057 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
15058 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
15059 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
15060 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
15061 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
15062 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
15063 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
15064 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010015065 connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive modes
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015066 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
15067 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015068
15069 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15070 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15071 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15072 of ms on remote networks.
15073
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015074 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15075 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15076 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015077
15078 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15079 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
15080 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
15081 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
15082 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
15083 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
15084 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
15085 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
15086 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
15087 to the server until another one is released.
15088
15089Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15090
15091 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
15092 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
15093 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
15094
15095 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
15096 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15097 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15098
15099 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
15100 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15101 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15102 flags.
15103
15104 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15105 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
15106 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15107 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15108 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15109 the client connection was maintained open.
15110
15111 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015112 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015113 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
15114 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15115
15116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151178.5. Session state at disconnection
15118-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015119
15120TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15121"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
151222-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15123each of which has a special meaning :
15124
15125 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15126 session to terminate :
15127
15128 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15129
15130 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15131 server explicitly refused it.
15132
15133 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15134 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15135 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15136 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015137 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15138
15139 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15140 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015141
15142 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15143 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15144 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15145 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15146 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15147
15148 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15149 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15150 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15151 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15152 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15153
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015154 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15155 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15156
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015157 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15158 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15159 backup connections when going up.
15160
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015161 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15162
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015163 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15164 send or receive data.
15165
15166 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15167 send or receive data.
15168
15169 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15170 with nothing left in the buffers.
15171
15172 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15173
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015174 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015175 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15176
15177 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15178 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15179 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15180 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15181 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15182
15183 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15184 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15185
15186 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15187 server (HTTP only).
15188
15189 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15190
15191 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15192 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15193 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15194
15195 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15196 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15197 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15198
15199 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15200
15201 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15202 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15203
15204 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15205 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15206 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15207
15208 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15209 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015210 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15211 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015212
15213 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15214 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15215 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15216 another server.
15217
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015218 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015219 server.
15220
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015221 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15222 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15223 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15224 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15225
15226 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15227 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15228 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15229 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15230
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015231 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15232 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15233 "use-server" rule).
15234
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015235 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15236
15237 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15238 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15239
15240 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15241
15242 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15243 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15244 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15245
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015246 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15247 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015248 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015249 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15250 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15251
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015252 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15253
15254 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15255 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15256
15257 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15258
15259 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15260
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015261The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15262was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015263helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15264starvation, attacks, etc...
15265
15266The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15267alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15268easier finding and understanding.
15269
15270 Flags Reason
15271
15272 -- Normal termination.
15273
15274 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15275 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15276 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15277 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15278
15279 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15280 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15281 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15282 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15283 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15284 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015285
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015286 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15287 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015288 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015289
15290 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15291 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15292 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15293
15294 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15295 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15296 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15297 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15298 the server takes too long to respond.
15299
15300 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15301 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15302 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15303 long a time to respond.
15304
15305 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15306 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15307 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15308 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015309 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15310 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015311
15312 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15313 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15314 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15315 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15316 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015317 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015318 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15319 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15320 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15321 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15322 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15323 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15324 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15325 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15326 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15327 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15328 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15329 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015330
15331 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15332 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015333 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15334 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15335 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15336 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015337
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015338 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15339 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015341 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015342 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15343 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15344 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15345 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15346 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15347
15348 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15349 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15350 503 or 504 here.
15351
15352 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15353 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15354 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15355 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15356 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15357
15358 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15359 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015360 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015361 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15362 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15363
15364 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15365 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15366 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15367 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15368 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15369 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15370 between haproxy and the server.
15371
15372 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15373 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15374 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15375 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15376 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15377 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15378 solution is to fix the application.
15379
15380 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15381 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15382 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15383 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15384 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15385 external attacks.
15386
15387 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15388 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015389 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015390 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15391 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15392
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015393 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15394 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15395 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015396 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15397 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015398
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015399 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15400 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15401 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15402 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015403 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15404 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15405 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15406 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15407 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015408
15409 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15410 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15411 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15412 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15413
15414 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15415 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15416 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15417 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15418
15419 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15420 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15421 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15422 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15423
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015424The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15425persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15426important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15427re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15428
15429 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15430
15431 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15432 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15433 set on a GET request.
15434
15435 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15436 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015437 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015438 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15439
15440 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15441 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15442 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15443
15444 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15445 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15446 already got a cookie.
15447
15448 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15449 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15450 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15451 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15452 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15453
15454 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15455 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15456 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15457
15458 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15459 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15460 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15461
15462 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15463 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15464
15465 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15466 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15467 then advertised in the response.
15468
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154708.6. Non-printable characters
15471-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015472
15473In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15474consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15475converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15476prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15477being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15478escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15479is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15480'}' when logging headers.
15481
15482Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15483issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15484containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15485
15486Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15487the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15488performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15489
15490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154918.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15492---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015493
15494Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15495achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015496section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015497cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15498the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15499the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015500locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015501not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15502user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15503a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15504wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15505
15506 Examples :
15507 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15508 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15509
15510 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15511 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15512
15513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15515---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015516
15517Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15518proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15519the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15520server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15521
15522Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15523response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015524section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015525
15526It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015527time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15528appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015529are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15530and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15531follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15532request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15533in the logs.
15534
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015535As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15536frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15537an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15538
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015539 Example :
15540 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15541 listen proxy-out
15542 mode http
15543 option httplog
15544 option logasap
15545 log global
15546 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15547
15548 # log the name of the virtual server
15549 capture request header Host len 20
15550
15551 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15552 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15553
15554 # log the beginning of the referrer
15555 capture request header Referer len 20
15556
15557 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15558 capture response header Server len 20
15559
15560 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15561 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15562
15563 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15564 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15565
15566 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15567 capture response header Via len 20
15568
15569 # log the URL location during a redirection
15570 capture response header Location len 20
15571
15572 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15573 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15574 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15575 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15576 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15577
15578 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15579 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15580 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15581 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015582 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015583
15584 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15585 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15586 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15587 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15588 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015589 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015590
15591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155928.9. Examples of logs
15593---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015594
15595These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15596them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15597reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15598
15599 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15600 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15601 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15602
15603 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15604 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15605
15606 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15607 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15608 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15609
15610 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15611 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15612
15613 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15614 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15615 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15616
15617 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015618 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015619 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15620 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15621
15622 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15623 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15624 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15625
15626 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15627 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015628 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015629 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15630 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15631 to return the 502 and not the server.
15632
15633 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015634 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015635
15636 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15637 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15638 Nothing was sent to any server.
15639
15640 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15641 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15642
15643 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15644 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15645 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15646 send a 408 return code to the client.
15647
15648 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15649 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15650
15651 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15652 5 seconds ("c----").
15653
15654 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15655 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015656 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015657
15658 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015659 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015660 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15661 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15662 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15663 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15664 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015665
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015666
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200156679. Supported filters
15668--------------------
15669
15670Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
15671accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
15672unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
15673
15674See also : "filter"
15675
156769.1. Trace
15677----------
15678
15679filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
15680
15681 Arguments:
15682 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
15683 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
15684
15685 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
15686 the client and the server. By default, this filter
15687 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
15688 only parses a random amount of the available data.
15689
15690 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
15691 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
15692 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
15693 amount of the parsed data.
15694
15695This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
15696callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
15697information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
15698filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
15699
15700Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
15701tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
15702a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
15703
15704
157059.2. HTTP compression
15706---------------------
15707
15708filter compression
15709
15710The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
15711keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
15712when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
15713use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
15714used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
15715filters evaluation order.
15716
15717See also : "compression"
15718
15719
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015720/*
15721 * Local variables:
15722 * fill-column: 79
15723 * End:
15724 */